Remove check for struct timezone, its result is never used.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blobd97c1aa7d291b0735b9b97ab9d157f7982641acd
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25 #include <config.h>
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
31 #include <stdio.h>
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
134 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
135 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
137 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
138 #ifndef XtNpickTop
139 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
140 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
141 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
142 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
144 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
146 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
147 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
148 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
149 #endif
151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
152 #include "widget.h"
153 #ifndef XtNinitialState
154 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
155 #endif
156 #endif
158 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
160 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
161 #ifdef USE_XIM
162 int use_xim = 1;
163 #else
164 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
165 #endif
169 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
171 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
173 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
174 start. */
176 static int any_help_event_p;
178 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
179 static Lisp_Object last_window;
181 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
183 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
185 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
187 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
189 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
190 use. */
192 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
194 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
195 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
196 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
197 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
199 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
201 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
202 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
203 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
204 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
206 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
208 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
210 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
212 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
213 /* The application context for Xt use. */
214 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
215 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
216 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
218 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
220 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
222 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
223 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
225 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
227 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
228 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
229 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
231 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
233 /* Mouse movement.
235 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
236 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
237 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
238 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
240 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
242 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
243 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
244 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
245 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
246 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
247 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
248 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
249 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
250 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
251 is off. */
253 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
255 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
256 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
257 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
259 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
261 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
262 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
263 an ordinary motion.
265 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
266 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
267 event. */
269 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
271 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
272 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
273 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
274 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
275 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
276 it's somewhat accurate. */
278 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
280 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
281 events. */
283 #ifdef __STDC__
284 static int volatile input_signal_count;
285 #else
286 static int input_signal_count;
287 #endif
289 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
291 static int x_noop_count;
293 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
295 extern char **initial_argv;
296 extern int initial_argc;
298 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
300 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
302 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
304 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
306 extern int errno;
308 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
310 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
312 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
314 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
315 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
316 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
318 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
319 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
321 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
322 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
324 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
325 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
326 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
327 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
329 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
330 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
331 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
332 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
333 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
334 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
335 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
336 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
337 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
338 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
339 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
340 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
341 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
342 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
343 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
344 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
345 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
346 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
347 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
348 enum text_cursor_kinds));
350 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
351 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
352 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
353 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
354 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
355 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
356 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
357 enum scroll_bar_part *,
358 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
359 unsigned long *));
360 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
362 static void x_sync_with_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
363 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
364 int *, struct input_event *));
365 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed P_ ((Display *, char *)) NO_RETURN;
368 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
370 static void
371 x_flush (f)
372 struct frame *f;
374 BLOCK_INPUT;
375 if (f == NULL)
377 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
378 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
379 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
381 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
382 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
383 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
387 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
388 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
389 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
390 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
391 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
392 performance. */
394 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
397 /***********************************************************************
398 Debugging
399 ***********************************************************************/
401 #if 0
403 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
404 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
406 struct record
408 char *locus;
409 int type;
412 struct record event_record[100];
414 int event_record_index;
416 record_event (locus, type)
417 char *locus;
418 int type;
420 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
421 event_record_index = 0;
423 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
424 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
425 event_record_index++;
428 #endif /* 0 */
432 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
434 struct x_display_info *
435 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
436 Display *dpy;
438 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
440 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
441 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
442 return dpyinfo;
444 return 0;
449 /***********************************************************************
450 Starting and ending an update
451 ***********************************************************************/
453 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
454 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
455 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
456 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
457 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
459 static void
460 x_update_begin (f)
461 struct frame *f;
463 /* Nothing to do. */
467 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
468 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
469 position of W. */
471 static void
472 x_update_window_begin (w)
473 struct window *w;
475 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
476 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
478 updated_window = w;
479 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
481 BLOCK_INPUT;
483 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
485 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
486 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
488 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
489 highlighting. */
490 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
491 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
493 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
494 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
495 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
496 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
497 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
498 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
500 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
501 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
502 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
503 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
504 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
505 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
506 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
508 int i;
510 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
511 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
512 break;
514 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
515 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
517 #endif /* 0 */
520 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
524 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
526 static void
527 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
528 struct window *w;
529 int x, y0, y1;
531 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
532 struct face *face;
534 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
535 if (face)
536 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
537 face->foreground);
539 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
540 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
543 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
545 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
546 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
548 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
549 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
550 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
552 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
553 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
554 here. */
556 static void
557 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
558 struct window *w;
559 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
561 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
563 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
565 BLOCK_INPUT;
567 if (cursor_on_p)
568 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
569 output_cursor.vpos,
570 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
572 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
573 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
575 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
578 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
579 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
580 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
582 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
583 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
584 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
587 updated_window = NULL;
591 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
592 update_end. */
594 static void
595 x_update_end (f)
596 struct frame *f;
598 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
599 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
601 #ifndef XFlush
602 BLOCK_INPUT;
603 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
604 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
605 #endif
609 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
610 complete update has been performed. The global variable
611 updated_window is not available here. */
613 static void
614 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
615 struct frame *f;
617 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
619 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
621 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
622 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
624 BLOCK_INPUT;
625 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
626 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
627 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
628 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
629 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
630 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
636 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
637 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
638 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
639 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
640 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
641 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
643 static void
644 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
645 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
647 struct window *w = updated_window;
648 struct frame *f;
649 int width, height;
651 xassert (w);
653 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
654 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
656 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
657 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
658 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
659 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
660 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
661 overhead is very small. */
662 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
663 && desired_row->full_width_p
664 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
665 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
666 width != 0)
667 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
668 height > 0))
670 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
672 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
673 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
674 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
675 y -= width;
677 BLOCK_INPUT;
678 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
679 0, y, width, height, False);
680 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
681 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
682 y, width, height, False);
683 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
687 static void
688 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
689 struct window *w;
690 struct glyph_row *row;
691 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
693 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
694 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
695 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
696 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
697 struct face *face = p->face;
698 int rowY;
700 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
701 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
702 if (p->y < rowY)
704 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
705 visible last row. */
706 int oldY = row->y;
707 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
708 row->visible_height = p->h;
709 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
710 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
711 row->y = oldY;
712 row->visible_height = oldVH;
714 else
715 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
717 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
719 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
720 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
721 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
722 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
723 if (face->stipple)
724 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
725 else
726 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
728 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
729 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
731 if (!face->stipple)
732 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
735 if (p->which)
737 unsigned char *bits;
738 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
739 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
740 XGCValues gcv;
742 if (p->wd > 8)
743 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
744 else
745 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
747 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
748 by the server. */
749 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
750 (p->cursor_p
751 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
752 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
753 : face->foreground),
754 face->background, depth);
756 if (p->overlay_p)
758 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
759 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
760 bits, p->wd, p->h,
761 1, 0, 1);
762 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
763 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
764 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
765 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
768 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
769 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
770 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
772 if (p->overlay_p)
774 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
775 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
776 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
780 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
785 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
786 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
787 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
788 rarely happens). */
790 static void
791 XTset_terminal_modes ()
795 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
796 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
798 static void
799 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
805 /***********************************************************************
806 Display Iterator
807 ***********************************************************************/
809 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
811 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
814 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
815 is not contained in the font. */
817 static XCharStruct *
818 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
819 XFontStruct *font;
820 XChar2b *char2b;
821 int font_type; /* unused on X */
823 /* The result metric information. */
824 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
826 xassert (font && char2b);
828 if (font->per_char != NULL)
830 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
832 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
833 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
834 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
835 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
836 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
837 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
838 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
839 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
840 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
841 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
843 else
845 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
846 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
847 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
848 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
850 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
851 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
853 where:
855 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
856 / = integer division
857 \ = integer modulus */
858 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
859 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
860 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
861 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
863 pcm = (font->per_char
864 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
865 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
866 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
870 else
872 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
873 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
874 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
875 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
876 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
877 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
880 return ((pcm == NULL
881 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
882 ? NULL : pcm);
886 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
887 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
889 static int
890 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
891 int c;
892 XChar2b *char2b;
893 struct font_info *font_info;
894 int *two_byte_p;
896 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
897 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
899 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
900 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
901 fixed encoding. */
902 if (font_info->font_encoder)
904 /* It's a program. */
905 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
907 check_ccl_update (ccl);
908 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
910 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
911 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
912 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
914 else
916 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
917 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
918 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
921 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
923 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
924 program. */
925 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
926 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
927 else
928 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
930 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
932 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
933 encoding numbers. */
934 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
936 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
937 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
938 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
940 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
941 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
944 if (two_byte_p)
945 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
947 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
952 /***********************************************************************
953 Glyph display
954 ***********************************************************************/
958 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
959 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
960 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
961 int));
962 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
963 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
964 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
968 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
971 unsigned long *, double, int));
972 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
973 double, int, unsigned long));
974 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
975 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
977 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
978 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
979 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
980 int, int, int));
981 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
982 int, int, int, int, int, int,
983 XRectangle *));
984 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
985 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
987 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
988 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
989 #endif
992 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
993 face. */
995 static void
996 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
997 struct glyph_string *s;
999 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1000 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1001 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1002 && !s->cmp)
1003 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1004 else
1006 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1007 XGCValues xgcv;
1008 unsigned long mask;
1010 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1011 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1013 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1014 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1015 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1016 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1017 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1018 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1019 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1021 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1022 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1023 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1025 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1026 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1029 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1030 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1031 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1032 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1034 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1035 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1036 mask, &xgcv);
1037 else
1038 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1039 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1041 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1046 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1048 static void
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1050 struct glyph_string *s;
1052 int face_id;
1053 struct face *face;
1055 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1056 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1057 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1058 if (face == NULL)
1059 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1061 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1062 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1063 else
1064 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1065 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1066 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1068 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1069 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1070 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1071 else
1073 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1074 but font FONT. */
1075 XGCValues xgcv;
1076 unsigned long mask;
1078 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1079 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1080 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1081 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1082 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1083 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1085 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1086 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1087 mask, &xgcv);
1088 else
1089 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1090 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1092 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1095 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1099 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1100 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1101 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1103 static INLINE void
1104 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1105 struct glyph_string *s;
1107 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1111 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1112 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1113 pattern. */
1115 static INLINE void
1116 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1117 struct glyph_string *s;
1119 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1121 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1123 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1124 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1126 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1128 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1129 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1133 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1134 s->stippled_p = 0;
1136 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1138 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1139 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1141 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1142 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1144 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1145 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1147 else
1149 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1150 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1153 /* GC must have been set. */
1154 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1158 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1159 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1161 static INLINE void
1162 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1163 struct glyph_string *s;
1165 XRectangle r;
1166 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1167 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1171 /* RIF:
1172 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1173 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1175 static void
1176 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1177 struct glyph_string *s;
1179 if (s->cmp == NULL
1180 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1182 XCharStruct cs;
1183 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1184 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1185 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1186 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1187 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1192 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1194 static INLINE void
1195 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1196 struct glyph_string *s;
1197 int x, y, w, h;
1199 XGCValues xgcv;
1200 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1201 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1202 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1203 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1207 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1208 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1209 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1210 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1211 contains the first component of a composition. */
1213 static void
1214 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1215 struct glyph_string *s;
1216 int force_p;
1218 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1219 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1220 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1222 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1224 if (s->stippled_p)
1226 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1227 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1228 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1229 s->y + box_line_width,
1230 s->background_width,
1231 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1232 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1233 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1235 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1236 || s->font_not_found_p
1237 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1238 || force_p)
1240 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1241 s->background_width,
1242 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1243 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1249 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1251 static void
1252 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1253 struct glyph_string *s;
1255 int i, x;
1257 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1258 of S to the right of that box line. */
1259 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1260 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1261 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1262 else
1263 x = s->x;
1265 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1266 loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1269 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1271 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1272 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1273 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1274 s->height - 1);
1275 x += g->pixel_width;
1278 else
1280 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1281 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1283 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1284 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1286 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1287 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1288 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1289 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1291 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1292 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1293 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1294 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1295 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1296 if (s->for_overlaps
1297 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1299 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1300 if (s->two_byte_p)
1301 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1302 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1303 else
1304 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1305 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1307 else
1309 if (s->two_byte_p)
1310 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1311 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1312 else
1313 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1314 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1317 if (s->face->overstrike)
1319 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1320 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1321 if (s->two_byte_p)
1322 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1323 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1324 else
1325 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1326 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1331 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1333 static void
1334 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1335 struct glyph_string *s;
1337 int i, x;
1339 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1340 of S to the right of that box line. */
1341 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1342 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1343 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1344 else
1345 x = s->x;
1347 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1348 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1349 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1350 this composition. */
1352 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1353 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1354 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1356 if (s->gidx == 0)
1357 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1358 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1360 else
1362 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1364 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1365 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1366 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1367 s->char2b + i, 1);
1368 if (s->face->overstrike)
1369 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1370 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1371 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1372 s->char2b + i, 1);
1378 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1380 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1381 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1382 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1383 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1384 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1387 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1388 cannot be determined. */
1390 static struct frame *
1391 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1392 Widget widget;
1394 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1395 Lisp_Object tail;
1396 struct frame *f;
1398 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1400 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1401 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1402 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1403 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1404 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1405 widget = XtParent (widget);
1407 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1408 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1409 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1410 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1411 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1412 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1413 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1414 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1415 return f;
1417 abort ();
1421 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1422 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1423 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1424 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1427 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1428 Widget widget;
1429 Colormap cmap;
1430 XColor *color;
1432 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1433 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1437 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1438 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1439 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1440 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1441 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1442 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1445 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1446 Widget widget;
1447 Display *display;
1448 Colormap cmap;
1449 unsigned long *pixel;
1450 double factor;
1451 int delta;
1453 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1454 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1458 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1459 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1461 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1463 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1464 sizeof (Screen *)},
1465 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1466 sizeof (Colormap)}
1470 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1471 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1473 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1476 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1478 DPY is the display we are working on.
1480 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1481 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1482 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1483 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1485 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1486 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1488 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1489 we allocated the color or not.
1491 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1493 static Boolean
1494 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1495 Display *dpy;
1496 XrmValue *args;
1497 Cardinal *nargs;
1498 XrmValue *from, *to;
1499 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1501 Screen *screen;
1502 Colormap cmap;
1503 Pixel pixel;
1504 String color_name;
1505 XColor color;
1507 if (*nargs != 2)
1509 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1510 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1511 "XtToolkitError",
1512 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1513 return False;
1516 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1517 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1518 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1520 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1522 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1523 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1525 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1527 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1528 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1531 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1533 pixel = color.pixel;
1534 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1536 else
1538 String params[1];
1539 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1541 params[0] = color_name;
1542 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1543 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1544 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1545 params, &nparams);
1546 return False;
1549 if (to->addr != NULL)
1551 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1553 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1554 return False;
1557 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1559 else
1561 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1562 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1565 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1566 return True;
1570 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1571 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1572 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1574 APP is the application context in which we work.
1576 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1577 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1578 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1580 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1582 static void
1583 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1584 XtAppContext app;
1585 XrmValuePtr to;
1586 XtPointer closure;
1587 XrmValuePtr args;
1588 Cardinal *nargs;
1590 if (*nargs != 2)
1592 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1593 "XtToolkitError",
1594 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1595 NULL, NULL);
1597 else if (closure != NULL)
1599 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1600 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1601 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1602 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1603 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1608 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1611 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1612 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1613 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1614 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1616 static const XColor *
1617 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1618 Display *dpy;
1619 int *ncells;
1621 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1623 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1625 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1626 int i;
1628 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1629 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1630 dpyinfo->color_cells
1631 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1632 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1634 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1635 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1637 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1638 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1641 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1642 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1646 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1647 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1649 void
1650 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1651 struct frame *f;
1652 XColor *colors;
1653 int ncolors;
1655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1657 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1659 int i;
1660 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1662 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1663 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1664 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1665 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1668 else
1669 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1673 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1674 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1676 void
1677 x_query_color (f, color)
1678 struct frame *f;
1679 XColor *color;
1681 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1685 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1686 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1687 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1688 allocated. */
1690 static int
1691 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1692 Display *dpy;
1693 Colormap cmap;
1694 XColor *color;
1696 int rc;
1698 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1699 if (rc == 0)
1701 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1702 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1703 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1704 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1705 int nearest, i;
1706 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1707 int ncells;
1708 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1710 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1712 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1713 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1714 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1715 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1717 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1719 nearest = i;
1720 nearest_delta = delta;
1724 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1725 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1726 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1727 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1729 else
1731 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1732 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1733 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1734 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1735 XColor *cached_color;
1737 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1738 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1739 (cached_color->red != color->red
1740 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1741 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1743 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1744 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1745 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1749 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1750 if (rc)
1751 register_color (color->pixel);
1752 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1754 return rc;
1758 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1759 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1760 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1761 allocated. */
1764 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1765 struct frame *f;
1766 Colormap cmap;
1767 XColor *color;
1769 gamma_correct (f, color);
1770 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1774 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1775 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1776 get color reference counts right. */
1778 unsigned long
1779 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1780 struct frame *f;
1781 unsigned long pixel;
1783 XColor color;
1785 color.pixel = pixel;
1786 BLOCK_INPUT;
1787 x_query_color (f, &color);
1788 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1789 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1790 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1791 register_color (pixel);
1792 #endif
1793 return color.pixel;
1797 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1798 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1799 get color reference counts right. */
1801 unsigned long
1802 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1803 Display *dpy;
1804 Colormap cmap;
1805 unsigned long pixel;
1807 XColor color;
1809 color.pixel = pixel;
1810 BLOCK_INPUT;
1811 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1812 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1813 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1814 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1815 register_color (pixel);
1816 #endif
1817 return color.pixel;
1821 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1822 boosted.
1824 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1825 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1826 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1827 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1828 use an additional additive factor.
1830 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1831 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1832 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1835 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1836 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1837 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1838 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1839 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1840 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1842 static int
1843 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1844 struct frame *f;
1845 Display *display;
1846 Colormap cmap;
1847 unsigned long *pixel;
1848 double factor;
1849 int delta;
1851 XColor color, new;
1852 long bright;
1853 int success_p;
1855 /* Get RGB color values. */
1856 color.pixel = *pixel;
1857 x_query_color (f, &color);
1859 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1860 xassert (factor >= 0);
1861 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1862 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1863 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1865 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1866 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1868 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1869 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1870 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1871 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1872 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1874 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1875 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1876 /* The additive adjustment. */
1877 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1879 if (factor < 1)
1881 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1882 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1883 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1885 else
1887 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1888 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1889 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1893 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1894 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1895 if (success_p)
1897 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1899 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1900 delta to the RGB values. */
1901 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1903 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1904 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1905 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1906 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1908 else
1909 success_p = 1;
1910 *pixel = new.pixel;
1913 return success_p;
1917 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1918 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1919 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1920 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1921 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1922 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1924 static void
1925 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1926 struct frame *f;
1927 struct relief *relief;
1928 double factor;
1929 int delta;
1930 unsigned long default_pixel;
1932 XGCValues xgcv;
1933 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1934 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1935 unsigned long pixel;
1936 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1937 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1938 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1939 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1941 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1942 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1944 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1945 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1946 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1947 if (relief->gc
1948 && relief->allocated_p)
1950 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1951 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1954 /* Allocate new color. */
1955 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1956 pixel = background;
1957 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1958 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1960 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1961 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1964 if (relief->gc == 0)
1966 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1967 mask |= GCStipple;
1968 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1970 else
1971 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1975 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1977 static void
1978 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1979 struct glyph_string *s;
1981 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1982 unsigned long color;
1984 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1985 color = s->face->box_color;
1986 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1987 && s->img->pixmap
1988 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1989 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1990 else
1992 XGCValues xgcv;
1994 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1995 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1996 color = xgcv.background;
1999 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2000 || color != di->relief_background)
2002 di->relief_background = color;
2003 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2004 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2005 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2006 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2011 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2012 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2013 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2014 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2015 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2016 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2017 when drawing. */
2019 static void
2020 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2021 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2022 struct frame *f;
2023 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2024 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2025 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2027 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2028 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2029 int i;
2030 GC gc;
2032 if (raised_p)
2033 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2034 else
2035 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2036 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2038 /* Top. */
2039 if (top_p)
2040 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2041 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2042 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2043 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2045 /* Left. */
2046 if (left_p)
2047 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2048 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2049 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2051 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2052 if (raised_p)
2053 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2054 else
2055 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2056 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2058 /* Bottom. */
2059 if (bot_p)
2060 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2061 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2062 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2063 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2065 /* Right. */
2066 if (right_p)
2067 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2068 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2069 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2071 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2075 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2076 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2077 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2078 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2079 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2080 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2082 static void
2083 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2084 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2085 struct glyph_string *s;
2086 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2087 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2089 XGCValues xgcv;
2091 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2092 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2093 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2095 /* Top. */
2096 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2097 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2099 /* Left. */
2100 if (left_p)
2101 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2102 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2104 /* Bottom. */
2105 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2106 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2108 /* Right. */
2109 if (right_p)
2110 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2111 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2113 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2114 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2118 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2120 static void
2121 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2122 struct glyph_string *s;
2124 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2125 int left_p, right_p;
2126 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2127 XRectangle clip_rect;
2129 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2130 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2131 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2133 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2134 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2135 ? s->first_glyph
2136 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2138 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2139 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2140 left_x = s->x;
2141 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2142 ? last_x - 1
2143 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2144 top_y = s->y;
2145 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2147 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2148 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2149 && (s->prev == NULL
2150 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2151 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2152 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2153 && (s->next == NULL
2154 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2156 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2158 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2159 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2160 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2161 else
2163 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2164 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2165 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2170 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2172 static void
2173 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2174 struct glyph_string *s;
2176 int x = s->x;
2177 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2179 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2180 right of that line. */
2181 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2182 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2183 && s->slice.x == 0)
2184 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2186 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2187 by that margin. */
2188 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2189 x += s->img->hmargin;
2190 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2191 y += s->img->vmargin;
2193 if (s->img->pixmap)
2195 if (s->img->mask)
2197 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2198 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2199 trust on the shape extension to be available
2200 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2201 manually. */
2202 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2203 | GCFunction);
2204 XGCValues xgcv;
2205 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2207 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2208 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2209 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2210 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2211 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2213 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2214 image_rect.x = x;
2215 image_rect.y = y;
2216 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2217 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2218 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2219 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2220 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2221 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2223 else
2225 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2227 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2228 image_rect.x = x;
2229 image_rect.y = y;
2230 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2231 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2232 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2233 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2234 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2235 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2237 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2238 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2239 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2240 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2241 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2242 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2243 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2245 int r = s->img->relief;
2246 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2247 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2248 x - r, y - r,
2249 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2250 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2254 else
2255 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2256 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2257 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2261 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2263 static void
2264 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2265 struct glyph_string *s;
2267 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2268 XRectangle r;
2269 int x = s->x;
2270 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2272 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2273 right of that line. */
2274 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2275 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2276 && s->slice.x == 0)
2277 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2279 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2280 by that margin. */
2281 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2282 x += s->img->hmargin;
2283 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2284 y += s->img->vmargin;
2286 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2287 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2289 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2290 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2292 else
2294 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2295 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2298 x0 = x - thick;
2299 y0 = y - thick;
2300 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2301 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2303 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2304 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2305 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2306 s->slice.y == 0,
2307 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2308 s->slice.x == 0,
2309 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2310 &r);
2314 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2316 static void
2317 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2318 struct glyph_string *s;
2319 Pixmap pixmap;
2321 int x = 0;
2322 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2324 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2325 right of that line. */
2326 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2327 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2328 && s->slice.x == 0)
2329 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2331 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2332 by that margin. */
2333 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2334 x += s->img->hmargin;
2335 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2336 y += s->img->vmargin;
2338 if (s->img->pixmap)
2340 if (s->img->mask)
2342 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2343 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2344 trust on the shape extension to be available
2345 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2346 manually. */
2347 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2348 | GCFunction);
2349 XGCValues xgcv;
2351 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2352 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2353 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2354 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2355 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2357 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2358 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2359 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2360 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2362 else
2364 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2365 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2366 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2368 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2369 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2370 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2371 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2372 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2373 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2374 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2376 int r = s->img->relief;
2377 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2378 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2379 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2380 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2384 else
2385 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2386 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2387 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2391 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2392 give the rectangle to draw. */
2394 static void
2395 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2396 struct glyph_string *s;
2397 int x, y, w, h;
2399 if (s->stippled_p)
2401 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2402 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2403 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2404 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2406 else
2407 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2411 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2413 s->y
2414 s->x +-------------------------
2415 | s->face->box
2417 | +-------------------------
2418 | | s->img->margin
2420 | | +-------------------
2421 | | | the image
2425 static void
2426 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2427 struct glyph_string *s;
2429 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2430 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2431 int height;
2432 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2434 height = s->height;
2435 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2436 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2437 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2438 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2440 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2441 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2442 flickering. */
2443 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2444 if (height > s->slice.height
2445 || s->img->hmargin
2446 || s->img->vmargin
2447 || s->img->mask
2448 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2449 || s->width != s->background_width)
2451 if (s->img->mask)
2453 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2454 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2455 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2456 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2457 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2459 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2460 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2461 s->background_width,
2462 s->height, depth);
2464 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2465 pixmap. */
2466 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2468 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2469 if (s->stippled_p)
2471 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2472 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2473 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2474 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2475 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2477 else
2479 XGCValues xgcv;
2480 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2481 &xgcv);
2482 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2483 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2484 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2485 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2488 else
2490 int x = s->x;
2491 int y = s->y;
2493 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2494 && s->slice.x == 0)
2495 x += box_line_hwidth;
2497 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2498 y += box_line_vwidth;
2500 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2503 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2506 /* Draw the foreground. */
2507 if (pixmap != None)
2509 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2510 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2511 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2512 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2513 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2515 else
2516 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2518 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2519 if (s->img->relief
2520 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2521 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2522 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2526 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2528 static void
2529 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2530 struct glyph_string *s;
2532 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2533 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2535 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2536 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2538 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2539 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2540 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2541 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2543 if (x < left_x)
2545 background_width -= left_x - x;
2546 x = left_x;
2548 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2550 /* Draw cursor. */
2551 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2553 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2554 if (width < background_width)
2556 int y = s->y;
2557 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2558 XRectangle r;
2559 GC gc;
2561 x += width;
2562 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2563 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2565 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2566 gc = s->gc;
2568 else
2569 gc = s->face->gc;
2571 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2572 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2574 if (s->face->stipple)
2576 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2577 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2578 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2579 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2581 else
2583 XGCValues xgcv;
2584 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2585 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2586 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2587 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2591 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2593 int background_width = s->background_width;
2594 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2596 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2597 except for header line and mode line. */
2598 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2600 background_width -= left_x - x;
2601 x = left_x;
2603 if (background_width > 0)
2604 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2607 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2611 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2613 static void
2614 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2615 struct glyph_string *s;
2617 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2619 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2620 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2621 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2622 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2624 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2625 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2626 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2627 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2630 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2631 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2633 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2634 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2635 if (!s->for_overlaps
2636 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2637 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2638 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2641 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2642 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2643 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2644 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2645 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2647 else
2648 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2650 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2652 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2653 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2654 break;
2656 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2657 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2658 break;
2660 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2661 if (s->for_overlaps)
2662 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2663 else
2664 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2665 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2666 break;
2668 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2669 if (s->for_overlaps || s->gidx > 0)
2670 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2671 else
2672 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2673 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2674 break;
2676 default:
2677 abort ();
2680 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2682 /* Draw underline. */
2683 if (s->face->underline_p)
2685 unsigned long tem, h;
2686 int y;
2688 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2689 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2690 h = 1;
2692 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2693 if (!x_underline_at_descent_line)
2695 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2696 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2697 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2698 specs, and its default is
2700 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2701 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2703 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2704 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2705 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2706 else if (s->face->font)
2707 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2710 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2711 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2712 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2713 else
2715 XGCValues xgcv;
2716 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2717 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2718 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2719 s->x, y, s->background_width, h);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2724 /* Draw overline. */
2725 if (s->face->overline_p)
2727 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2729 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2730 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2731 s->background_width, h);
2732 else
2734 XGCValues xgcv;
2735 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2736 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2737 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2738 s->background_width, h);
2739 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2743 /* Draw strike-through. */
2744 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2746 unsigned long h = 1;
2747 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2749 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2750 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2751 s->width, h);
2752 else
2754 XGCValues xgcv;
2755 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2756 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2757 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2758 s->width, h);
2759 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2763 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2764 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2765 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2768 /* Reset clipping. */
2769 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2772 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2774 void
2775 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2776 struct frame *f;
2777 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2779 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2780 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2781 x, y, width, height,
2782 x + shift_by, y);
2785 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2786 for X frames. */
2788 static void
2789 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2790 register int n;
2792 abort ();
2796 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2797 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2799 void
2800 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2801 Display *dpy;
2802 Window window;
2803 int x, y;
2804 int width, height;
2805 int exposures;
2807 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2808 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2812 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2813 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2815 static void
2816 x_clear_frame ()
2818 struct frame *f;
2820 if (updating_frame)
2821 f = updating_frame;
2822 else
2823 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2825 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2826 longer visible. */
2827 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2828 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2829 output_cursor.x = -1;
2831 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2832 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2833 BLOCK_INPUT;
2834 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2836 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2837 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2838 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2840 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2842 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2847 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2849 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2850 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2852 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2855 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2856 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2858 static int
2859 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2860 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2862 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2863 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2864 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2866 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2867 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2868 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2871 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2873 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2874 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2875 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2878 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2879 positive. */
2880 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2881 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2883 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2884 negative. */
2885 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2888 void
2889 XTflash (f)
2890 struct frame *f;
2892 BLOCK_INPUT;
2895 GC gc;
2897 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2898 pixels into background pixels. */
2900 XGCValues values;
2902 values.function = GXxor;
2903 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2904 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2906 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2907 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2911 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2912 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2913 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2914 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2915 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2916 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2917 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2919 int width;
2921 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2922 edge it is next to. */
2923 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2925 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2926 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2927 break;
2929 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2930 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2931 break;
2933 default:
2934 break;
2937 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2939 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2940 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2942 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2943 flash_left,
2944 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2945 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2946 width, flash_height);
2947 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2948 flash_left,
2949 (height - flash_height
2950 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2951 width, flash_height);
2953 else
2954 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2955 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2956 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2957 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2959 x_flush (f);
2962 struct timeval wakeup;
2964 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2966 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2967 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2968 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2969 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2971 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2972 available. */
2973 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2975 struct timeval current;
2976 struct timeval timeout;
2978 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2980 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2981 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2982 break;
2984 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2985 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2986 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2988 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2989 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2993 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2994 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2996 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2997 flash_left,
2998 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2999 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3000 width, flash_height);
3001 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3002 flash_left,
3003 (height - flash_height
3004 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3005 width, flash_height);
3007 else
3008 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3009 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3010 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3011 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3013 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3014 x_flush (f);
3018 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3021 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3024 /* Make audible bell. */
3026 void
3027 XTring_bell ()
3029 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3031 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3033 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3034 if (visible_bell)
3035 XTflash (f);
3036 else
3037 #endif
3039 BLOCK_INPUT;
3040 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3041 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3042 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3048 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3049 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3050 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3051 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3053 static void
3054 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3055 register int n;
3057 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3062 /***********************************************************************
3063 Line Dance
3064 ***********************************************************************/
3066 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3067 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3069 static void
3070 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3071 int vpos, n;
3073 abort ();
3077 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3079 static void
3080 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3081 struct window *w;
3082 struct run *run;
3084 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3085 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3087 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3088 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3089 fringe of W. */
3090 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3092 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3093 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3094 bottom_y = y + height;
3096 if (to_y < from_y)
3098 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3099 line at the bottom. */
3100 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3101 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3102 else
3103 height = run->height;
3105 else
3107 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3108 at the bottom. */
3109 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3110 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3111 else
3112 height = run->height;
3115 BLOCK_INPUT;
3117 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3118 updated_window = w;
3119 x_clear_cursor (w);
3121 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3122 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3123 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3124 x, from_y,
3125 width, height,
3126 x, to_y);
3128 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3133 /***********************************************************************
3134 Exposure Events
3135 ***********************************************************************/
3138 static void
3139 frame_highlight (f)
3140 struct frame *f;
3142 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3143 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3144 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3145 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3146 BLOCK_INPUT;
3147 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3148 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3149 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3150 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3153 static void
3154 frame_unhighlight (f)
3155 struct frame *f;
3157 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3158 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3159 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3160 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3161 BLOCK_INPUT;
3162 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3163 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3164 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3165 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3168 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3169 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3170 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3171 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3172 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3174 static void
3175 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3176 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3177 struct frame *frame;
3179 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3181 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3183 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3184 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3185 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3187 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3188 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3190 #if 0
3191 selected_frame = frame;
3192 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3193 selected_frame);
3194 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3195 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3196 #endif /* ! 0 */
3198 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3199 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3200 else
3201 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3204 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3207 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3208 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3209 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3211 static void
3212 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3213 int type;
3214 int state;
3215 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3216 struct frame *frame;
3217 struct input_event *bufp;
3219 if (type == FocusIn)
3221 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3223 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3224 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3226 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3227 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3228 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3229 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3230 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3232 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3233 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3237 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3239 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3240 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3241 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3242 #endif
3244 else if (type == FocusOut)
3246 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3248 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3250 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3251 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3254 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3255 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3256 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3257 #endif
3261 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3262 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3264 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3266 static void
3267 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3268 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3269 XEvent *event;
3270 struct input_event *bufp;
3272 struct frame *frame;
3274 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3275 if (! frame)
3276 return;
3278 switch (event->type)
3280 case EnterNotify:
3281 case LeaveNotify:
3283 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3284 int focus_state
3285 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3287 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3288 && event->xcrossing.focus
3289 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3290 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3291 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3292 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3294 break;
3296 case FocusIn:
3297 case FocusOut:
3298 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3299 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3300 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3301 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3302 break;
3307 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3309 void
3310 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3311 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3313 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3316 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3317 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3318 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3320 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3321 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3322 the appropriate X display info. */
3324 static void
3325 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3326 struct frame *frame;
3328 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3331 static void
3332 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3333 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3335 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3337 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3339 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3340 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3341 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3342 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3343 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3345 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3346 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3349 else
3350 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3352 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3354 if (old_highlight)
3355 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3356 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3357 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3363 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3365 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3366 static void
3367 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3368 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3370 int min_code, max_code;
3371 KeySym *syms;
3372 int syms_per_code;
3373 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3375 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3376 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3377 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3378 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3379 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3381 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3382 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3383 #else
3384 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3385 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3386 #endif
3388 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3389 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3390 &syms_per_code);
3391 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3393 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3394 Alt keysyms are on. */
3396 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3397 int found_alt_or_meta;
3399 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3401 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3402 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3404 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3406 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3407 if (code == 0)
3408 continue;
3410 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3412 int code_col;
3414 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3416 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3418 switch (sym)
3420 case XK_Meta_L:
3421 case XK_Meta_R:
3422 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3423 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3424 break;
3426 case XK_Alt_L:
3427 case XK_Alt_R:
3428 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3429 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3430 break;
3432 case XK_Hyper_L:
3433 case XK_Hyper_R:
3434 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3435 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3436 code_col = syms_per_code;
3437 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3438 break;
3440 case XK_Super_L:
3441 case XK_Super_R:
3442 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3443 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3444 code_col = syms_per_code;
3445 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3446 break;
3448 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3449 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3450 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3451 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3452 code_col = syms_per_code;
3453 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3454 break;
3462 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3463 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3465 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3466 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3469 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3470 make them just meta, not alt. */
3471 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3473 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3476 XFree ((char *) syms);
3477 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3480 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3481 Emacs uses. */
3483 unsigned int
3484 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3485 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3486 unsigned int state;
3488 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3489 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3490 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3491 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3492 Lisp_Object tem;
3494 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3495 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3496 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3497 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3498 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3499 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3500 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3501 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3504 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3505 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3506 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3507 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3508 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3509 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3512 static unsigned int
3513 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3514 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3515 unsigned int state;
3517 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3518 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3519 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3520 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3522 Lisp_Object tem;
3524 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3525 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3526 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3527 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3528 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3529 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3530 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3531 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3534 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3535 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3536 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3537 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3538 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3539 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3542 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3544 char *
3545 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3546 KeySym keysym;
3548 char *value;
3550 BLOCK_INPUT;
3551 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3552 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3554 return value;
3559 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3561 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3563 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3564 the mouse. */
3566 static Lisp_Object
3567 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3568 struct input_event *result;
3569 XButtonEvent *event;
3570 struct frame *f;
3572 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3573 otherwise. */
3574 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3575 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3576 result->timestamp = event->time;
3577 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3578 event->state)
3579 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3580 ? up_modifier
3581 : down_modifier));
3583 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3584 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3585 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3586 result->arg = Qnil;
3587 return Qnil;
3591 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3592 The input handler calls this.
3594 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3595 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3596 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3597 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3599 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3600 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3602 static int
3603 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3604 FRAME_PTR frame;
3605 XMotionEvent *event;
3607 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3608 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3609 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3611 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3612 return 0;
3614 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3616 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3617 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3618 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3619 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3620 return 1;
3624 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3625 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3626 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3627 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3628 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3629 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3631 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3632 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3633 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3634 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3635 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3636 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3637 return 1;
3640 return 0;
3644 /************************************************************************
3645 Mouse Face
3646 ************************************************************************/
3648 static void
3649 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3651 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3652 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3653 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3654 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3655 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3660 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3661 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3663 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3664 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3665 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3666 position on the scroll bar.
3668 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3669 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3670 the mouse is over.
3672 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3673 was at this position.
3675 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3677 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3678 movement. */
3680 static void
3681 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3682 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3683 int insist;
3684 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3685 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3686 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3687 unsigned long *time;
3689 FRAME_PTR f1;
3691 BLOCK_INPUT;
3693 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3694 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3695 else
3697 Window root;
3698 int root_x, root_y;
3700 Window dummy_window;
3701 int dummy;
3703 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3705 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3706 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3707 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3708 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3710 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3712 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3713 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3714 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3716 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3717 &root,
3719 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3720 a different screen. */
3721 &dummy_window,
3723 /* The position on that root window. */
3724 &root_x, &root_y,
3726 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3727 &dummy, &dummy,
3729 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3730 we don't care. */
3731 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3733 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3734 containing the pointer. */
3736 Window win, child;
3737 int win_x, win_y;
3738 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3740 win = root;
3742 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3743 structure is changing at the same time this function
3744 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3746 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3748 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3749 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3751 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3752 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3753 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3755 /* From-window, to-window. */
3756 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3758 /* From-position, to-position. */
3759 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3761 /* Child of win. */
3762 &child);
3763 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3765 else
3767 while (1)
3769 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3771 /* From-window, to-window. */
3772 root, win,
3774 /* From-position, to-position. */
3775 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3777 /* Child of win. */
3778 &child);
3780 if (child == None || child == win)
3781 break;
3783 win = child;
3784 parent_x = win_x;
3785 parent_y = win_y;
3788 /* Now we know that:
3789 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3790 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3791 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3792 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3793 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3794 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3795 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3796 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3797 never use them in that case.) */
3799 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3800 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3802 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3803 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3804 on the frame. */
3805 if (f1 != NULL
3806 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3807 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3808 f1 = NULL;
3809 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3812 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3813 f1 = 0;
3815 x_uncatch_errors ();
3817 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3818 if (! f1)
3820 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3822 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3824 if (bar)
3826 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3827 win_x = parent_x;
3828 win_y = parent_y;
3832 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3833 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3835 if (f1)
3837 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3838 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3839 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3840 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3841 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3842 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3843 the frame are divided into. */
3845 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3846 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3848 *bar_window = Qnil;
3849 *part = 0;
3850 *fp = f1;
3851 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3852 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3853 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3858 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3863 /***********************************************************************
3864 Scroll bars
3865 ***********************************************************************/
3867 /* Scroll bar support. */
3869 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3870 manages it.
3871 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3872 bits. */
3874 static struct scroll_bar *
3875 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3876 Display *display;
3877 Window window_id;
3879 Lisp_Object tail;
3881 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3882 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3883 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3885 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3886 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3887 tail = XCDR (tail))
3889 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3891 frame = XCAR (tail);
3892 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3893 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3894 abort ();
3896 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3897 right window ID. */
3898 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3899 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3900 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3901 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3902 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3903 condemned = Qnil,
3904 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3905 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3906 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3907 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3908 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3911 return 0;
3915 #if defined USE_LUCID
3917 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3918 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3920 static Widget
3921 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3922 Window window;
3924 Lisp_Object tail;
3926 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3927 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3928 tail = XCDR (tail))
3930 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3931 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3933 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3934 return menu_bar;
3937 return NULL;
3940 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3943 /************************************************************************
3944 Toolkit scroll bars
3945 ************************************************************************/
3947 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3949 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3950 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3951 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3952 struct scroll_bar *));
3953 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3954 int, int, int));
3957 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3958 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3960 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3962 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3964 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3966 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3967 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3969 #ifndef USE_GTK
3970 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3972 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3974 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3976 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3977 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3978 to avoid jerkyness. */
3980 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3982 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3983 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3984 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3985 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3987 static void
3988 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3989 num_params)
3990 Widget widget;
3991 XtPointer client_data;
3992 String action_name;
3993 XEvent *event;
3994 String *params;
3995 Cardinal *num_params;
3997 int scroll_bar_p;
3998 char *end_action;
4000 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4001 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4002 end_action = "Release";
4003 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4004 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4005 end_action = "EndScroll";
4006 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4008 if (scroll_bar_p
4009 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4010 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4012 struct window *w;
4014 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4015 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4016 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4018 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4020 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4021 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4022 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4024 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4025 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4027 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4028 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4031 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4033 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4034 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4036 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4037 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4040 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4041 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4042 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4043 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4045 static void
4046 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4047 Lisp_Object window;
4048 int part, portion, whole;
4050 XEvent event;
4051 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4052 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4053 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4054 int i;
4056 BLOCK_INPUT;
4058 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4059 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4060 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4061 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4062 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4063 ev->format = 32;
4065 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4066 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4067 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4068 into that array in the event. */
4069 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4070 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4071 break;
4073 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4075 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4076 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4077 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4079 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4080 nbytes);
4081 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4082 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4085 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4086 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4087 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4088 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4089 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4090 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4092 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4093 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4094 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4095 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4096 #endif
4098 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4099 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4100 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4101 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4106 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4107 in *IEVENT. */
4109 static void
4110 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4111 XEvent *event;
4112 struct input_event *ievent;
4114 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4115 Lisp_Object window;
4116 struct frame *f;
4117 struct window *w;
4119 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4120 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4122 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4123 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4125 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4126 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4127 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4128 #ifdef USE_GTK
4129 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4130 #else
4131 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4132 #endif
4133 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4134 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4135 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4136 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4137 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4141 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4143 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4145 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4148 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4149 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4150 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4152 static void
4153 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4154 Widget widget;
4155 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4157 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4158 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4159 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4161 switch (cs->reason)
4163 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4164 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4165 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4166 break;
4168 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4169 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4170 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4171 break;
4173 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4174 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4175 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4176 break;
4178 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4179 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4180 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4181 break;
4183 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4184 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4185 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4186 break;
4188 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4189 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4190 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4191 break;
4193 case XmCR_DRAG:
4195 int slider_size;
4197 /* Get the slider size. */
4198 BLOCK_INPUT;
4199 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4200 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4202 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4203 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4204 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4205 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4207 break;
4209 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4210 break;
4213 if (part >= 0)
4215 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4216 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4217 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4222 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4223 #ifdef USE_GTK
4224 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4225 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4227 static void
4228 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4229 GtkRange *widget;
4230 gpointer data;
4232 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4233 gdouble previous;
4234 gdouble position;
4235 gdouble *p;
4236 int diff;
4238 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4239 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4241 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4243 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4244 if (! p)
4246 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4247 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4248 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4251 previous = *p;
4252 *p = position;
4254 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4256 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4258 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4260 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4261 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4263 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4265 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4266 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4268 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4270 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4271 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4273 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4275 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4276 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4278 else
4280 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4281 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4282 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4283 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4286 if (part >= 0)
4288 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4289 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4290 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4294 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4296 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4297 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4298 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4299 the thumb is. */
4301 static void
4302 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4303 Widget widget;
4304 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4306 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4307 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4308 float shown;
4309 int whole, portion, height;
4310 int part;
4312 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4313 BLOCK_INPUT;
4314 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4315 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4317 whole = 10000000;
4318 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4320 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4321 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4322 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4323 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4324 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4325 bottom). */
4326 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4327 else
4328 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4330 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4331 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4332 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4333 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4337 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4338 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4339 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4340 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4341 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4342 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4343 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4345 static void
4346 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4347 Widget widget;
4348 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4350 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4351 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4352 int position = (long) call_data;
4353 Dimension height;
4354 int part;
4356 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4357 BLOCK_INPUT;
4358 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4359 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4361 if (abs (position) >= height)
4362 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4364 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4365 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4366 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4367 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4368 else
4369 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4371 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4372 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4373 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4374 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4377 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4378 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4380 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4382 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4383 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4385 #ifdef USE_GTK
4386 static void
4387 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4388 struct frame *f;
4389 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4391 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4393 BLOCK_INPUT;
4394 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4395 scroll_bar_name);
4396 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4399 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4401 static void
4402 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4403 struct frame *f;
4404 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4406 Window xwindow;
4407 Widget widget;
4408 Arg av[20];
4409 int ac = 0;
4410 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4411 unsigned long pixel;
4413 BLOCK_INPUT;
4415 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4416 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4417 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4418 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4419 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4420 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4421 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4422 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4423 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4425 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4426 if (pixel != -1)
4428 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4429 ++ac;
4432 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4433 if (pixel != -1)
4435 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4436 ++ac;
4439 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4440 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4442 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4443 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4444 (XtPointer) bar);
4445 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4446 (XtPointer) bar);
4447 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4448 (XtPointer) bar);
4449 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4450 (XtPointer) bar);
4451 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4452 (XtPointer) bar);
4453 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4454 (XtPointer) bar);
4455 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4456 (XtPointer) bar);
4458 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4459 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4461 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4462 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4463 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4464 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4466 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4468 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4469 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4470 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4471 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4472 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4473 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4474 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4475 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4477 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4478 if (pixel != -1)
4480 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4481 ++ac;
4484 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4485 if (pixel != -1)
4487 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4488 ++ac;
4491 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4493 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4494 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4496 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4497 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4498 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4499 pixel = -1;
4500 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4502 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4504 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4505 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4506 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4507 pixel = -1;
4508 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4511 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4512 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4513 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4514 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4515 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4516 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4518 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4519 ++ac;
4521 else
4522 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4523 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4524 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4526 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4527 the shadows. */
4528 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4529 ++ac;
4531 /* Specify the colors. */
4532 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4533 if (pixel != -1)
4535 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4536 ++ac;
4538 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4539 if (pixel != -1)
4541 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4542 ++ac;
4545 #endif
4547 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4548 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4551 char *initial = "";
4552 char *val = initial;
4553 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4554 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4555 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4556 #endif
4557 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4558 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4559 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4560 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4561 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4562 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4566 /* Define callbacks. */
4567 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4568 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4569 (XtPointer) bar);
4571 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4572 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4574 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4576 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4577 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4578 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4579 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4581 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4582 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4583 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4584 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4586 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4588 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4591 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4592 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4594 #ifdef USE_GTK
4595 static void
4596 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4597 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4598 int portion, position, whole;
4600 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4603 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4604 static void
4605 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4606 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4607 int portion, position, whole;
4609 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4610 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4611 float top, shown;
4613 BLOCK_INPUT;
4615 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4617 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4618 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4619 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4620 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4621 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4622 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4623 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4624 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4625 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4626 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4627 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4628 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4629 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4630 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4631 whole += portion;
4633 if (whole <= 0)
4634 top = 0, shown = 1;
4635 else
4637 top = (float) position / whole;
4638 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4641 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4643 int size, value;
4645 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4646 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4647 value. */
4648 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4649 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4650 size = max (size, 1);
4652 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4653 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4654 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4656 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4658 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4660 if (whole == 0)
4661 top = 0, shown = 1;
4662 else
4664 top = (float) position / whole;
4665 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4669 float old_top, old_shown;
4670 Dimension height;
4671 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4672 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4673 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4674 XtNheight, &height,
4675 NULL);
4677 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4678 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4679 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4680 else
4681 top = old_top;
4682 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4683 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4685 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4686 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4687 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4688 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4690 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4691 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4692 else
4694 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4695 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4696 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4698 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4702 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4704 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4706 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4708 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4712 /************************************************************************
4713 Scroll bars, general
4714 ************************************************************************/
4716 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4717 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4718 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4719 scroll bar. */
4721 static struct scroll_bar *
4722 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4723 struct window *w;
4724 int top, left, width, height;
4726 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4727 struct scroll_bar *bar
4728 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4730 BLOCK_INPUT;
4732 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4733 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4734 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4736 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4737 unsigned long mask;
4738 Window window;
4740 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4741 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4742 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4744 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4745 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4746 | ExposureMask);
4747 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4749 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4751 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4752 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4753 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4754 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4755 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4756 left, top, width,
4757 window_box_height (w), False);
4759 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4760 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4761 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4762 top,
4763 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4764 height,
4765 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4767 CopyFromParent,
4768 CopyFromParent,
4769 CopyFromParent,
4770 /* Attributes. */
4771 mask, &a);
4772 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4774 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4776 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4777 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4778 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4779 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4780 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4781 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4782 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4783 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4785 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4786 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4787 bar->prev = Qnil;
4788 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4789 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4790 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4792 /* Map the window/widget. */
4793 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4795 #ifdef USE_GTK
4796 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4797 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4798 top,
4799 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4800 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4801 max (height, 1));
4802 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4803 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4804 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4805 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4806 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4807 top,
4808 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4809 max (height, 1), 0);
4810 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4811 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4813 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4814 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4815 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4817 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4818 return bar;
4822 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4824 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4825 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4826 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4827 events.)
4829 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4830 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4831 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4832 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4833 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4835 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4837 static void
4838 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4839 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4840 int start, end;
4841 int rebuild;
4843 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4844 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4845 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4846 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4848 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4849 if (! rebuild
4850 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4851 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4852 return;
4854 BLOCK_INPUT;
4857 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4858 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4859 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4861 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4862 the distance between start and end. */
4864 int length = end - start;
4866 if (start < 0)
4867 start = 0;
4868 else if (start > top_range)
4869 start = top_range;
4870 end = start + length;
4872 if (end < start)
4873 end = start;
4874 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4875 end = top_range;
4878 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4879 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4880 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4882 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4883 if (end > top_range)
4884 end = top_range;
4886 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4887 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4888 that many pixels tall. */
4889 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4891 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4892 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4893 if (0 < start)
4894 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4895 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4896 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4897 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4898 inside_width, start,
4899 False);
4901 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4902 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4903 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4904 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4906 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4907 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4908 /* x, y, width, height */
4909 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4910 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4911 inside_width, end - start);
4913 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4914 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4915 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4916 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4918 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4919 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4920 if (end < inside_height)
4921 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4922 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4923 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4924 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4925 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4926 False);
4930 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4933 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4935 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4936 nil. */
4938 static void
4939 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4940 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4942 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4943 BLOCK_INPUT;
4945 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4946 #ifdef USE_GTK
4947 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4948 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4949 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4950 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4951 #else
4952 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4953 #endif
4955 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4956 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4958 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4962 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4963 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4964 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4965 create one. */
4967 static void
4968 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4969 struct window *w;
4970 int portion, whole, position;
4972 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4973 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4974 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4975 int window_y, window_height;
4977 /* Get window dimensions. */
4978 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4979 top = window_y;
4980 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4981 height = window_height;
4983 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4984 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4986 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4987 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4988 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4989 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4990 else
4991 sb_width = width;
4993 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
4994 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4995 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
4996 sb_left = (left +
4997 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
4998 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
4999 : 0));
5000 else
5001 sb_left = (left +
5002 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5003 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5004 : width - sb_width));
5005 #else
5006 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5007 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5008 else
5009 sb_left = left;
5010 #endif
5012 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5013 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5015 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5017 BLOCK_INPUT;
5018 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5019 left, top, width, height, False);
5020 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5023 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5025 else
5027 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5028 unsigned int mask = 0;
5030 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5032 BLOCK_INPUT;
5034 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5035 mask |= CWX;
5036 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5037 mask |= CWY;
5038 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5039 mask |= CWWidth;
5040 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5041 mask |= CWHeight;
5043 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5045 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5046 if (mask)
5048 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5049 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5050 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5051 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5052 left, top, width, height, False);
5053 #ifdef USE_GTK
5054 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5055 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5056 top,
5057 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5058 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5059 max (height, 1));
5060 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5061 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5062 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5063 top,
5064 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5065 max (height, 1), 0);
5066 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5068 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5070 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5071 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5072 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5074 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5075 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5076 height, False);
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5079 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5080 height, False);
5083 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5084 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5085 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5086 example. */
5088 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5089 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5090 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5092 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5093 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5094 left + area_width - rest, top,
5095 rest, height, False);
5096 else
5097 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5098 left, top, rest, height, False);
5102 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5103 if (mask)
5105 XWindowChanges wc;
5107 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5108 wc.y = top;
5109 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5110 wc.height = height;
5111 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5112 mask, &wc);
5115 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5117 /* Remember new settings. */
5118 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5119 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5120 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5121 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5123 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5126 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5127 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5128 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5129 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5130 dragged. */
5131 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5133 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5135 if (whole == 0)
5136 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5137 else
5139 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5140 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5141 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5144 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5146 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5150 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5151 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5152 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5153 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5154 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5155 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5156 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5158 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5159 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5160 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5162 static void
5163 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5164 FRAME_PTR frame;
5166 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5167 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5169 Lisp_Object bar;
5170 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5171 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5172 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5173 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5174 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5175 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5176 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5181 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5182 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5184 static void
5185 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5186 struct window *window;
5188 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5189 struct frame *f;
5191 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5192 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5193 abort ();
5195 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5197 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5198 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5199 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5201 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5202 the lists. */
5203 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5204 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5205 return;
5206 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5207 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5208 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5209 else
5210 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5211 one or the other! */
5212 abort ();
5214 else
5215 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5217 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5218 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5220 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5221 bar->prev = Qnil;
5222 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5223 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5224 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5227 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5228 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5230 static void
5231 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5232 FRAME_PTR f;
5234 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5236 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5238 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5239 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5240 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5242 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5244 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5246 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5248 next = b->next;
5249 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5252 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5253 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5257 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5258 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5259 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5261 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5262 mark bits. */
5264 static void
5265 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5266 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5267 XEvent *event;
5269 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5270 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5271 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5272 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5274 BLOCK_INPUT;
5276 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5278 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5279 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5281 /* x, y, width, height */
5282 0, 0,
5283 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5284 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5286 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5289 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5291 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5292 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5294 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5295 mark bits. */
5298 static void
5299 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5300 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5301 XEvent *event;
5302 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5304 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5305 abort ();
5307 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5308 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5309 emacs_event->modifiers
5310 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5311 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5312 event->xbutton.state)
5313 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5314 ? up_modifier
5315 : down_modifier));
5316 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5317 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5318 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5320 #if 0
5321 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5322 int internal_height
5323 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5324 #endif
5325 int top_range
5326 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5327 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5329 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5330 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5332 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5333 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5334 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5335 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5336 else
5337 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5339 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5340 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5341 whether or not we're dragging. */
5342 #if 0
5343 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5344 holding it. */
5345 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5346 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5347 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5348 #endif
5350 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5351 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5352 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5353 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5355 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5356 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5358 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5359 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5361 #endif
5363 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5364 #if 0
5365 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5366 the handle. */
5367 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5368 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5369 else
5370 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5371 #else
5372 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5373 #endif
5375 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5379 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5381 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5383 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5384 mark bits. */
5386 static void
5387 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5388 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5389 XEvent *event;
5391 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5393 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5395 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5396 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5398 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5399 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5401 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5402 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5404 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5406 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5408 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5413 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5415 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5416 on the scroll bar. */
5418 static void
5419 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5420 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5421 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5422 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5423 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5424 unsigned long *time;
5426 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5427 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5428 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5429 int win_x, win_y;
5430 Window dummy_window;
5431 int dummy_coord;
5432 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5434 BLOCK_INPUT;
5436 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5437 report that. */
5438 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5440 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5441 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5442 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5444 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5445 &win_x, &win_y,
5447 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5448 &dummy_mask))
5450 else
5452 #if 0
5453 int inside_height
5454 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5455 #endif
5456 int top_range
5457 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5459 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5461 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5462 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5464 if (win_y < 0)
5465 win_y = 0;
5466 if (win_y > top_range)
5467 win_y = top_range;
5469 *fp = f;
5470 *bar_window = bar->window;
5472 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5473 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5474 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5475 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5476 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5477 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5478 else
5479 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5481 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5482 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5484 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5485 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5488 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5490 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5494 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5495 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5496 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5497 redraw them. */
5499 void
5500 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5501 FRAME_PTR f;
5503 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5504 Lisp_Object bar;
5506 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5507 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5508 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5509 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5510 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5511 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5512 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5513 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5514 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5515 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5519 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5521 #if 0
5522 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5523 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5524 sometimes don't work. */
5526 static Time enter_timestamp;
5527 #endif
5529 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5530 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5531 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5532 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5534 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5535 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5537 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5539 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5540 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5542 static int temp_index;
5543 static short temp_buffer[100];
5545 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5546 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5547 temp_index = 0; \
5548 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5550 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5551 on a particular display. */
5553 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5555 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5556 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5557 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5558 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5560 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5562 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5563 do \
5565 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5566 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5567 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5568 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5569 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5570 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5572 while (0)
5574 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5575 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5578 enum
5580 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5581 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5582 X_EVENT_DROP
5585 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5586 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5587 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5589 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5590 this event further.
5591 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5593 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5594 static int
5595 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5596 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5597 XEvent *event;
5599 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5600 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5601 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5602 was created. */
5604 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5605 event->xclient.window);
5607 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5609 #endif
5611 #ifdef USE_GTK
5612 static int current_count;
5613 static int current_finish;
5614 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5616 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5617 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5618 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5619 static GdkFilterReturn
5620 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5621 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5622 GdkEvent *ev;
5623 gpointer data;
5625 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5627 if (current_count >= 0)
5629 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5631 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5633 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5634 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5635 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5636 so we do it here. */
5637 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5638 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5639 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5640 #endif
5642 if (! dpyinfo)
5643 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5644 else
5646 current_count +=
5647 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5648 current_hold_quit);
5651 else
5652 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5654 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5655 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5657 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5659 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5662 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5664 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5665 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5666 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5668 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5670 static int
5671 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5672 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5673 XEvent *eventp;
5674 int *finish;
5675 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5677 union {
5678 struct input_event ie;
5679 struct selection_input_event sie;
5680 } inev;
5681 int count = 0;
5682 int do_help = 0;
5683 int nbytes = 0;
5684 struct frame *f;
5685 struct coding_system coding;
5686 XEvent event = *eventp;
5688 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5690 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5691 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5692 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5694 switch (event.type)
5696 case ClientMessage:
5698 if (event.xclient.message_type
5699 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5700 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5702 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5703 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5705 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5706 could be the shell widget window
5707 if the frame has no title bar. */
5708 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5709 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5710 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5711 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5712 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5713 #endif
5714 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5715 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5716 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5717 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5718 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5719 needed.
5721 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5722 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5723 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5724 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5725 Emacs. */
5727 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5728 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5729 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5730 if (f)
5732 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5733 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5734 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5735 x_catch_errors (d);
5736 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5737 /* The ICCCM says this is
5738 the only valid choice. */
5739 RevertToParent,
5740 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5741 /* This is needed to detect the error
5742 if there is an error. */
5743 XSync (d, False);
5744 x_uncatch_errors ();
5746 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5747 #endif /* 0 */
5748 goto done;
5751 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5752 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5754 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5755 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5756 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5757 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5758 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5759 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5760 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5761 session manager and one for this. */
5762 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5763 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5764 #endif
5766 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5767 event.xclient.window);
5768 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5769 for a single Emacs process. */
5770 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5771 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5772 event.xclient.window,
5773 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5774 else if (f)
5775 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5776 event.xclient.window,
5777 0, 0);
5779 goto done;
5782 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5783 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5785 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5786 event.xclient.window);
5787 if (!f)
5788 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5790 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5791 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5792 goto done;
5795 goto done;
5798 if (event.xclient.message_type
5799 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5801 goto done;
5804 if (event.xclient.message_type
5805 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5807 int new_x, new_y;
5808 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5810 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5811 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5813 if (f)
5815 f->left_pos = new_x;
5816 f->top_pos = new_y;
5818 goto done;
5821 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5822 if (event.xclient.message_type
5823 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5825 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5826 if (f)
5827 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5828 &event, NULL);
5829 goto done;
5831 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5833 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5834 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5835 || (event.xclient.message_type
5836 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5838 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5839 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5840 currently never do because we are interested in
5841 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5842 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5843 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5844 if (!f)
5845 goto OTHER;
5846 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5847 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5848 goto done;
5851 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5852 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5853 we construct an input_event. */
5854 if (event.xclient.message_type
5855 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5857 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5858 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5859 goto done;
5861 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5863 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5864 if (!f)
5865 goto OTHER;
5866 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5867 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5869 break;
5871 case SelectionNotify:
5872 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5873 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5874 goto OTHER;
5875 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5876 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5877 break;
5879 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5880 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5881 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5882 goto OTHER;
5883 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5885 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5887 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5888 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5889 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5890 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5891 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5893 break;
5895 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5896 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5897 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5898 goto OTHER;
5899 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5901 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5902 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5904 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5905 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5906 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5907 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5908 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5909 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5910 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5911 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5913 break;
5915 case PropertyNotify:
5916 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5917 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5918 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5919 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5920 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5921 goto OTHER;
5922 #endif
5923 #endif
5924 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5925 goto OTHER;
5927 case ReparentNotify:
5928 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5929 if (f)
5931 int x, y;
5932 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5933 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5934 f->left_pos = x;
5935 f->top_pos = y;
5937 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5938 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5940 goto OTHER;
5942 case Expose:
5943 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5944 if (f)
5946 x_check_fullscreen (f);
5948 #ifdef USE_GTK
5949 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5950 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5951 event.xexpose.window,
5952 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5953 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5954 FALSE);
5955 #endif
5956 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5958 f->async_visible = 1;
5959 f->async_iconified = 0;
5960 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5961 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5963 else
5964 expose_frame (f,
5965 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5966 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5968 else
5970 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5971 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5972 #endif
5973 #if defined USE_LUCID
5974 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5975 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5976 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5978 Widget widget
5979 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
5980 if (widget)
5981 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
5983 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5985 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5986 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
5987 goto OTHER;
5988 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5989 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
5990 event.xexpose.window);
5992 if (bar)
5993 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
5994 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5995 else
5996 goto OTHER;
5997 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5998 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6000 break;
6002 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6003 source area was obscured or not
6004 available. */
6005 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6006 if (f)
6008 expose_frame (f,
6009 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6010 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6011 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6013 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6014 else
6015 goto OTHER;
6016 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6017 break;
6019 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6020 source area was completely
6021 available. */
6022 break;
6024 case UnmapNotify:
6025 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6026 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6028 tip_window = 0;
6029 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6032 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6033 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6034 the frame was deleted. */
6036 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6037 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6038 display that won't ever be seen. */
6039 f->async_visible = 0;
6040 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6041 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6042 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6043 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6044 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6045 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6046 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6048 f->async_iconified = 1;
6050 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6051 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6054 goto OTHER;
6056 case MapNotify:
6057 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6058 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6059 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6060 goto OTHER;
6062 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6063 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6064 frame is visible. */
6065 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6066 if (f)
6068 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6069 the frame's display structures.
6070 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6071 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6072 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6073 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6074 if (! f->async_iconified)
6075 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6077 f->async_visible = 1;
6078 f->async_iconified = 0;
6079 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6081 if (f->iconified)
6083 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6084 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6086 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6087 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6088 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6089 to update the frame titles
6090 in case this is the second frame. */
6091 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6093 goto OTHER;
6095 case KeyPress:
6097 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6099 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6100 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6101 if (popup_activated ())
6102 goto OTHER;
6103 #endif
6105 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6107 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6108 mouse highlighting. */
6109 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6110 && (f == 0
6111 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6113 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6114 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6117 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6118 if (f == 0)
6120 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6121 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6122 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6123 event.xkey.window);
6124 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6126 widget = XtParent (widget);
6127 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6130 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6132 if (f != 0)
6134 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6135 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6136 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6137 his Emacs hang.
6139 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6140 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6141 status_return even if the input is too long to
6142 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6143 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6144 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6145 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6146 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6147 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6148 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6149 int modifiers;
6150 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6151 Lisp_Object c;
6153 #ifdef USE_GTK
6154 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6155 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6156 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6157 (see above). */
6158 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6159 #endif
6161 event.xkey.state
6162 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6163 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6164 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6166 /* This will have to go some day... */
6168 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6169 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6170 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6171 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6172 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6173 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6174 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6176 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6177 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6178 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6179 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6180 not it is combined with Meta. */
6181 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6182 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6184 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6185 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6187 Status status_return;
6189 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6190 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6191 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6192 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6193 &status_return);
6194 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6196 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6197 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6198 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6199 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6200 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6201 &status_return);
6203 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6204 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6205 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6206 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6207 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6208 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6209 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6210 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6211 &status_return);
6212 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6214 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6215 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6216 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6217 &event.xkey,
6218 copy_bufptr,
6219 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6220 &status_return);
6223 #endif
6225 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6226 break;
6227 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6229 keysym = NoSymbol;
6230 modifiers = 0;
6232 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6233 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6234 abort ();
6236 else
6237 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6238 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6239 &compose_status);
6240 #else
6241 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6242 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6243 &compose_status);
6244 #endif
6246 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6247 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6248 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6249 break;
6251 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6252 orig_keysym = keysym;
6254 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6255 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6256 inev.ie.modifiers
6257 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6258 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6260 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6261 translations to characters. */
6262 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6263 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6265 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6266 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6267 goto done_keysym;
6270 /* Keysyms directly mapped to supported Unicode characters. */
6271 if ((keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x010033ff)
6272 || (keysym >= 0x0100e000 && keysym <= 0x0100ffff))
6274 int code = keysym & 0xFFFF, charset_id, c1, c2;
6276 if (code < 0x80)
6278 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6279 inev.ie.code = code;
6281 else if (code < 0x100)
6283 if (code < 0xA0)
6284 charset_id = CHARSET_8_BIT_CONTROL;
6285 else
6286 charset_id = charset_latin_iso8859_1;
6287 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6288 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, code, 0);
6290 else
6292 if (code < 0x2500)
6293 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_0100_24ff,
6294 code -= 0x100;
6295 else if (code < 0xE000)
6296 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_2500_33ff,
6297 code -= 0x2500;
6298 else
6299 charset_id = charset_mule_unicode_e000_ffff,
6300 code -= 0xE000;
6301 c1 = (code / 96) + 32, c2 = (code % 96) + 32;
6302 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6303 inev.ie.code = MAKE_CHAR (charset_id, c1, c2);
6305 goto done_keysym;
6308 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6309 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6310 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6311 Vx_keysym_table,
6312 Qnil))))
6314 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6315 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6316 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6317 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6318 goto done_keysym;
6321 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6322 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6323 || keysym == XK_Delete
6324 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6325 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6326 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6327 #endif
6328 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6329 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6330 #ifdef HPUX
6331 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6332 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6333 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6334 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6335 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6336 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6337 #endif
6338 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6339 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6340 #endif
6341 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6342 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6343 #endif
6344 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6345 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6346 #endif
6347 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6348 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6349 #endif
6350 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6351 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6352 #endif
6353 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6354 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6355 #endif
6356 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6357 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6358 #endif
6359 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6360 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6361 #endif
6362 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6363 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6364 #endif
6365 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6366 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6367 #endif
6368 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6369 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6370 #endif
6371 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6372 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6373 #endif
6374 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6375 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6376 #endif
6377 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6378 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6379 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6380 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6381 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6382 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6383 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6384 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6385 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6386 #endif
6387 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6388 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6389 #endif
6390 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6391 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6392 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6393 don't have real modifiers but
6394 should be treated similarly to
6395 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6396 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6397 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6398 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6399 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6400 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6401 #endif
6404 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6405 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6406 key. */
6407 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6408 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6409 goto done_keysym;
6412 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6413 register int i;
6414 register int c;
6415 int nchars, len;
6417 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6418 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6419 we used just above and the locale. */
6420 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6421 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6422 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6423 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6424 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6425 gives us composition information. */
6426 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6428 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6430 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6434 /* Decode the input data. */
6435 int require;
6436 unsigned char *p;
6438 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6439 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6440 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6441 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6442 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6443 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6444 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6445 nbytes = coding.produced;
6446 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6447 copy_bufptr = p;
6450 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6451 character events. */
6452 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6454 if (nchars == nbytes)
6455 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6456 else
6457 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6458 nbytes - i, len);
6459 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6460 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6461 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6462 inev.ie.code = c;
6463 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6466 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6467 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6468 count += nbytes;
6470 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6472 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6473 break;
6476 done_keysym:
6477 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6478 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6479 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6480 client. */
6481 break;
6482 #else
6483 goto OTHER;
6484 #endif
6486 case KeyRelease:
6487 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6488 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6489 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6490 client. */
6491 break;
6492 #else
6493 goto OTHER;
6494 #endif
6496 case EnterNotify:
6497 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6499 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6501 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6502 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6504 #if 0
6505 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6507 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6508 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6509 || !(f->auto_lower)
6510 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6512 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6513 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6516 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6517 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6518 #endif
6520 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6521 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6522 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6523 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6524 #ifdef USE_GTK
6525 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6526 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6527 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6528 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6529 #endif
6530 goto OTHER;
6532 case FocusIn:
6533 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6534 goto OTHER;
6536 case LeaveNotify:
6537 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6539 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6540 if (f)
6542 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6544 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6545 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6546 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6547 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6550 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6551 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6552 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6553 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6554 if (any_help_event_p)
6555 do_help = -1;
6557 #ifdef USE_GTK
6558 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6559 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6560 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event);
6561 #endif
6562 goto OTHER;
6564 case FocusOut:
6565 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6566 goto OTHER;
6568 case MotionNotify:
6570 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6571 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6573 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6574 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6575 f = last_mouse_frame;
6576 else
6577 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6579 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6581 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6582 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6585 if (f)
6588 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6589 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window))
6591 Lisp_Object window;
6593 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6594 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6595 0, 0, 0, 0);
6597 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6598 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6599 will be selected iff it is active. */
6600 if (WINDOWP (window)
6601 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6602 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6604 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6605 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6608 last_window=window;
6610 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6611 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6613 else
6615 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6616 struct scroll_bar *bar
6617 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6618 event.xmotion.window);
6620 if (bar)
6621 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6622 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6624 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6625 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6626 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6629 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6630 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6631 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6632 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6633 do_help = 1;
6634 goto OTHER;
6637 case ConfigureNotify:
6638 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6639 if (f)
6641 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6642 #ifdef USE_GTK
6643 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6644 event.xconfigure.height);
6645 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6646 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6647 do this one, the right one will come later.
6648 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6649 need to reset it below. */
6650 int dont_resize
6651 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6652 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6653 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6654 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6656 if (dont_resize)
6657 goto OTHER;
6659 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6660 is called by the code that handles resizing
6661 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6663 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6664 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6665 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6666 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6667 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6668 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6669 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6671 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6672 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6673 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6675 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6676 #endif
6678 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6679 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6681 #ifdef USE_GTK
6682 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6683 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6684 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6685 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6686 #endif
6688 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6690 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6691 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6694 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6695 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6696 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6697 #endif
6699 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6701 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6702 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6703 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6704 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6707 goto OTHER;
6709 case ButtonRelease:
6710 case ButtonPress:
6712 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6713 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6714 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6716 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6717 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6719 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6720 && last_mouse_frame
6721 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6722 f = last_mouse_frame;
6723 else
6724 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6726 if (f)
6728 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6729 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6730 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6732 Lisp_Object window;
6733 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6734 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6736 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6737 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6739 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6740 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6741 else
6742 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6743 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6744 event.xbutton.state));
6745 tool_bar_p = 1;
6749 if (!tool_bar_p)
6750 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6751 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6753 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6754 if (! popup_activated ())
6755 #endif
6757 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6759 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6760 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6762 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6763 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6765 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6766 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6768 else
6769 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6773 else
6775 struct scroll_bar *bar
6776 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6777 event.xbutton.window);
6779 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6780 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6781 scroll bars. */
6782 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6784 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6785 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6787 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6788 if (bar)
6789 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6790 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6793 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6795 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6796 last_mouse_frame = f;
6798 if (!tool_bar_p)
6799 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6801 else
6802 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6804 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6805 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6806 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6807 if (f != 0)
6808 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6810 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6811 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6812 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6813 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6814 Instead, save it away
6815 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6816 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6817 if (
6818 #ifdef USE_GTK
6819 ! popup_activated ()
6821 #endif
6822 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6823 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6824 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6825 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6826 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6827 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6828 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6829 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6831 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6832 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6833 #ifdef USE_GTK
6834 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6835 #endif
6837 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6839 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6840 goto OTHER;
6843 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6844 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6845 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6847 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6849 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6850 if (f->output_data.x)
6851 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6853 else
6854 goto OTHER;
6856 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6857 else
6858 goto OTHER;
6859 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6861 break;
6863 case CirculateNotify:
6864 goto OTHER;
6866 case CirculateRequest:
6867 goto OTHER;
6869 case VisibilityNotify:
6870 goto OTHER;
6872 case MappingNotify:
6873 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6874 local cache. */
6875 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6877 case MappingModifier:
6878 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6879 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6880 case MappingKeyboard:
6881 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6883 goto OTHER;
6885 default:
6886 OTHER:
6887 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6888 BLOCK_INPUT;
6889 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6890 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6891 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6892 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6893 break;
6896 done:
6897 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6899 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6900 count++;
6903 if (do_help
6904 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6906 Lisp_Object frame;
6908 if (f)
6909 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6910 else
6911 frame = Qnil;
6913 if (do_help > 0)
6915 any_help_event_p = 1;
6916 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6917 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6919 else
6921 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6922 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6924 count++;
6927 *eventp = event;
6928 return count;
6932 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6933 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6934 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6936 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6938 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6939 XEvent *event;
6940 Display *display;
6942 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6943 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6945 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6947 if (dpyinfo)
6948 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6950 return finish;
6954 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6955 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6956 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6958 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6959 thus pretending to be `read'.
6961 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6963 static int
6964 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6965 register int sd;
6966 int expected;
6967 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6969 int count = 0;
6970 XEvent event;
6971 int event_found = 0;
6972 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6974 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6976 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6977 return -1;
6980 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6981 BLOCK_INPUT;
6983 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6984 input_signal_count++;
6986 ++handling_signal;
6988 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6989 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6990 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6992 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6993 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6994 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6995 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6996 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6997 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6998 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6999 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7000 #endif
7002 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7003 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7004 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7005 for X connections. */
7006 #ifndef SIGIO
7007 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7008 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7010 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7011 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7012 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7013 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7015 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7016 #endif /* SIGIO */
7017 #endif
7019 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7020 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7022 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7023 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7026 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7028 struct input_event inev;
7029 BLOCK_INPUT;
7030 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7031 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7032 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7034 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7035 count++;
7037 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7039 #endif
7041 #ifndef USE_GTK
7042 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7044 int finish;
7046 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7048 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7049 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7050 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7051 break;
7052 #endif
7053 event_found = 1;
7055 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7057 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7058 goto out;
7060 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7063 #ifdef USE_GTK
7065 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7066 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7067 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7068 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7070 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7071 from all displays. */
7073 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7075 current_count = count;
7076 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7078 gtk_main_iteration ();
7080 count = current_count;
7081 current_count = -1;
7082 current_hold_quit = 0;
7084 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7085 break;
7087 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7089 out:;
7091 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7092 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7093 if (! event_found)
7095 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7096 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7097 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7098 x_noop_count++;
7099 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7101 x_noop_count=0;
7103 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7104 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7106 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7108 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7109 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7113 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7114 raise it now. */
7115 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7116 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7118 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7119 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7122 --handling_signal;
7123 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7125 return count;
7131 /***********************************************************************
7132 Text Cursor
7133 ***********************************************************************/
7135 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7136 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7138 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7139 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7140 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7142 static void
7143 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7144 struct window *w;
7145 struct glyph_row *row;
7146 int area;
7147 GC gc;
7149 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7150 XRectangle clip_rect;
7151 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7153 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7155 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7156 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7157 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7158 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7159 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7161 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7165 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7167 static void
7168 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7169 struct window *w;
7170 struct glyph_row *row;
7172 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7173 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7174 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7175 int x, y, wd, h;
7176 XGCValues xgcv;
7177 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7178 GC gc;
7180 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7181 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7182 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7183 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7184 return;
7186 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7187 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7188 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7190 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7191 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7192 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7193 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7194 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7195 else
7196 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7197 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7198 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7200 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7201 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7202 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7203 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7207 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7209 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7210 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7211 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7212 --gerd. */
7214 static void
7215 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7216 struct window *w;
7217 struct glyph_row *row;
7218 int width;
7219 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7221 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7222 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7224 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7225 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7226 and mini-buffer. */
7227 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7228 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7229 return;
7231 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7232 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7233 the bar might not be in the window. */
7234 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7236 struct glyph_row *row;
7237 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7238 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7240 else
7242 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7243 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7244 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7245 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7246 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7247 XGCValues xgcv;
7249 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7250 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7251 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7252 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7253 that the glyph is legible. */
7254 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7255 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7256 else
7257 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7258 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7260 if (gc)
7261 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7262 else
7264 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7265 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7268 if (width < 0)
7269 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7270 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7272 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7273 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7275 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7276 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7277 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7278 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7279 width, row->height);
7280 else
7281 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7282 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7283 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7284 row->height - width),
7285 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7286 width);
7288 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7293 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7295 static void
7296 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7297 struct frame *f;
7298 Cursor cursor;
7300 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7304 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7306 static void
7307 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7308 struct frame *f;
7309 int x, y, width, height;
7311 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7312 x, y, width, height, False);
7316 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7318 static void
7319 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7320 struct window *w;
7321 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7322 int x, y;
7323 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7324 int on_p, active_p;
7326 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7328 if (on_p)
7330 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7331 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7333 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7334 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7336 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7337 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7339 else
7340 switch (cursor_type)
7342 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7343 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7344 break;
7346 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7347 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7348 break;
7350 case BAR_CURSOR:
7351 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7352 break;
7354 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7355 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7356 break;
7358 case NO_CURSOR:
7359 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7360 break;
7362 default:
7363 abort ();
7366 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7367 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7368 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7369 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7370 #endif
7373 #ifndef XFlush
7374 if (updating_frame != f)
7375 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7376 #endif
7380 /* Icons. */
7382 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7385 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7386 struct frame *f;
7387 Lisp_Object file;
7389 int bitmap_id;
7391 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7392 return 1;
7394 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7395 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7396 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7397 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7399 if (STRINGP (file))
7401 #ifdef USE_GTK
7402 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7403 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7404 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7405 return 0;
7406 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7407 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7408 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7410 else
7412 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7413 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7415 int rc = -1;
7417 #if defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7418 #ifdef USE_GTK
7419 if (xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7420 return 0;
7421 #else
7422 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7423 if (rc != -1)
7424 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7425 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7426 #endif /* defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS) */
7428 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7429 if (rc == -1)
7431 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7432 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7433 if (rc == -1)
7434 return 1;
7436 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7437 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7441 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7442 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7443 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7444 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7445 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7447 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7450 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7451 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7453 return 0;
7457 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7458 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7461 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7462 struct frame *f;
7463 char *icon_name;
7465 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7466 return 1;
7468 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7470 XTextProperty text;
7471 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7472 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7473 text.format = 8;
7474 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7475 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7477 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7478 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7479 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7481 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7482 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7483 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7484 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7486 return 0;
7489 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7491 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7492 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7494 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7495 be called from a signal handler.
7498 struct x_error_message_stack {
7499 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7500 Display *dpy;
7501 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7503 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7505 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7506 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7507 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7509 static void
7510 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7511 Display *display;
7512 XErrorEvent *error;
7514 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7515 x_error_message->string,
7516 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7519 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7520 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7521 operating on.
7523 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7524 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7525 stored in *x_error_message.
7527 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7528 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7530 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7532 void x_check_errors ();
7534 void
7535 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7536 Display *dpy;
7538 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7540 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7541 XSync (dpy, False);
7543 data->dpy = dpy;
7544 data->string[0] = 0;
7545 data->prev = x_error_message;
7546 x_error_message = data;
7549 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7550 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7552 void
7553 x_uncatch_errors ()
7555 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7557 BLOCK_INPUT;
7559 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7560 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7561 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7562 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7564 tmp = x_error_message;
7565 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7566 xfree (tmp);
7567 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7570 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7571 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7572 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7574 void
7575 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7576 Display *dpy;
7577 char *format;
7579 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7580 XSync (dpy, False);
7582 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7584 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7585 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7586 x_uncatch_errors ();
7587 error (format, string);
7591 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7592 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7595 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7596 Display *dpy;
7598 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7599 XSync (dpy, False);
7601 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7604 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7606 void
7607 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7608 Display *dpy;
7610 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7613 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7615 void
7616 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7618 while (x_error_message)
7619 x_uncatch_errors ();
7622 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7625 x_catching_errors ()
7627 return x_error_message != 0;
7630 #if 0
7631 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7632 x_trace_wire ()
7634 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7636 #endif /* ! 0 */
7639 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7640 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7641 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7642 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7643 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7645 static SIGTYPE
7646 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7647 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7649 #ifdef USG
7650 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7651 must reestablish each time */
7652 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7653 #endif /* USG */
7657 /************************************************************************
7658 Handling X errors
7659 ************************************************************************/
7661 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7663 static char *error_msg;
7665 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7666 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7667 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7669 static void
7670 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7672 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7673 exit (70);
7676 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7677 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7679 static SIGTYPE
7680 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7681 Display *dpy;
7682 char *error_message;
7684 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7685 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7687 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7688 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7689 handling_signal = 0;
7691 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7692 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7693 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7694 the original message here. */
7695 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7697 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7698 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7699 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7701 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7702 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7703 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7705 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7706 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7708 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7709 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7710 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7712 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7713 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7714 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7715 if (dpyinfo)
7717 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7718 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7719 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7720 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7722 #endif
7724 #ifdef USE_GTK
7725 if (dpyinfo)
7726 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7727 #endif
7729 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7730 if (dpyinfo)
7731 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7733 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7734 that are on the dead display. */
7735 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7737 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7738 minibuf_frame
7739 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7740 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7741 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7742 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7743 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7744 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7747 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7748 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7749 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7750 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7751 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7752 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7754 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7755 trying to find a replacement. */
7756 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7757 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7760 if (dpyinfo)
7761 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7763 x_uncatch_errors ();
7765 if (x_display_list == 0)
7767 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7768 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7769 exit (70);
7772 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7773 #ifdef SIGIO
7774 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7775 #endif
7776 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7777 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7779 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7780 error ("%s", error_msg);
7783 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7784 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7785 static void x_error_quitter P_ ((Display *, XErrorEvent *));
7787 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7788 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7790 static int
7791 x_error_handler (display, error)
7792 Display *display;
7793 XErrorEvent *error;
7795 if (x_error_message)
7796 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7797 else
7798 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7799 return 0;
7802 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7803 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7804 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7806 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7808 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7809 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7810 #else
7811 #define NO_INLINE
7812 #endif
7814 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7816 #ifdef noinline
7817 #undef noinline
7818 #endif
7820 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7821 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7823 static void NO_INLINE
7824 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7825 Display *display;
7826 XErrorEvent *error;
7828 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7830 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7831 or colors that are not defined. */
7833 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7834 return;
7836 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7837 original error handler. */
7839 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7840 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7841 buf, error->request_code);
7842 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7846 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7847 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7848 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7850 static int
7851 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7852 Display *display;
7854 char buf[256];
7856 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7857 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7858 return 0;
7861 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7863 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7864 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7865 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7866 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7868 Lisp_Object
7869 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7870 struct frame *f;
7871 register char *fontname;
7873 struct font_info *fontp
7874 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7876 if (!fontp)
7877 return Qnil;
7879 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7880 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7881 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7883 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7884 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7885 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7887 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7889 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7890 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7892 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7893 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7894 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7896 else
7898 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7899 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7902 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7903 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7905 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7906 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7907 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7908 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7909 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7910 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7912 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7913 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7914 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7915 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7916 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7919 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7922 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7923 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7924 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7925 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7927 Lisp_Object
7928 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7929 struct frame *f;
7930 char *fontsetname;
7932 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7933 Lisp_Object result;
7935 if (fontset < 0)
7936 return Qnil;
7938 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7939 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7940 to do. */
7941 return fontset_name (fontset);
7943 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7945 if (!STRINGP (result))
7946 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7947 return Qnil;
7949 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7950 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7952 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7953 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7954 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7955 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7956 #endif
7958 return build_string (fontsetname);
7962 /***********************************************************************
7963 X Input Methods
7964 ***********************************************************************/
7966 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7968 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7970 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7971 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7972 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7974 static void
7975 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7976 XIM xim;
7977 XPointer client_data;
7978 XPointer call_data;
7980 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7981 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7983 BLOCK_INPUT;
7985 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7986 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7988 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7989 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7991 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7992 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7996 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7997 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7998 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7999 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8002 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8004 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8005 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8006 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8007 #endif
8009 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8010 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8012 static void
8013 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8014 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8015 char *resource_name;
8017 XIM xim;
8019 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8020 if (use_xim)
8022 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8023 EMACS_CLASS);
8024 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8026 if (xim)
8028 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8029 XIMCallback destroy;
8030 #endif
8032 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8033 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8035 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8036 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8037 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8038 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8039 #endif
8043 else
8044 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8045 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8049 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8051 struct xim_inst_t
8053 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8054 char *resource_name;
8057 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8058 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8059 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8060 when the callback was registered. */
8062 static void
8063 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8064 Display *display;
8065 XPointer client_data;
8066 XPointer call_data;
8068 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8069 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8071 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8072 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8073 return;
8075 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8077 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8078 as they have no XIC. */
8079 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8081 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8083 BLOCK_INPUT;
8084 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8086 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8088 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8089 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8091 create_frame_xic (f);
8092 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8093 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8094 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8096 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8097 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8102 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8106 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8109 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8110 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8111 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8112 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8114 static void
8115 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8116 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8117 char *resource_name;
8119 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8120 if (use_xim)
8122 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8123 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8124 int len;
8126 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8127 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8128 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8129 len = strlen (resource_name);
8130 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8131 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8132 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8133 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8134 xim_instantiate_callback,
8135 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8136 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8137 least, hence the configure test. */
8138 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8139 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8140 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8141 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8142 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8145 else
8146 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8147 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8151 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8153 static void
8154 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8155 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8157 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8158 if (use_xim)
8160 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8161 if (dpyinfo->display)
8162 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8163 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8164 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8165 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8166 if (dpyinfo->display)
8167 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8168 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8169 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8171 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8174 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8178 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8179 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8181 void
8182 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8183 struct frame *f;
8185 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8187 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8188 is already for the top-left corner. */
8189 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8190 return;
8192 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8193 position that fits on the screen. */
8194 if (flags & XNegative)
8195 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8196 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8199 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8201 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8202 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8203 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8205 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8206 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8207 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8208 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8209 is right, though.
8211 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8212 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8214 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8215 #endif
8217 if (flags & YNegative)
8218 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8221 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8222 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8223 so the flags should correspond. */
8224 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8227 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8228 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8229 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8230 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8231 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8233 void
8234 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8235 struct frame *f;
8236 register int xoff, yoff;
8237 int change_gravity;
8239 int modified_top, modified_left;
8241 if (change_gravity != 0)
8243 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8244 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8246 f->top_pos = yoff;
8247 f->left_pos = xoff;
8248 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8249 if (xoff < 0)
8250 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8251 if (yoff < 0)
8252 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8253 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8255 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8257 BLOCK_INPUT;
8258 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8260 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8261 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8263 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8265 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8266 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8267 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8268 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8269 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8272 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8273 modified_left, modified_top);
8275 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8276 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8277 ? 1 : 0);
8279 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8280 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8281 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8282 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8283 of the frame.
8285 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8286 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8287 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8289 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8290 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8291 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8292 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8293 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8294 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8296 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8299 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8300 static int
8301 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f)
8302 struct frame *f;
8304 int have_net_atom = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->have_net_atoms;
8306 if (!have_net_atom)
8308 int num;
8309 Atom *atoms = XListProperties (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8310 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
8311 &num);
8312 if (atoms && num > 0)
8314 char **names = (char **) xmalloc (num * sizeof(*names));
8315 if (XGetAtomNames (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), atoms, num, names))
8317 int i;
8318 for (i = 0; i < num; ++i)
8320 if (!have_net_atom)
8321 have_net_atom = strncmp (names[i], "_NET_", 5) == 0;
8322 XFree (names[i]);
8325 xfree (names);
8327 if (atoms)
8328 XFree (atoms);
8330 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->have_net_atoms = have_net_atom;
8333 if (have_net_atom)
8335 Lisp_Object frame;
8336 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8337 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8338 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8339 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8340 const char *what = NULL;
8342 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8344 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8345 hints. */
8346 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8348 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8349 what = fs;
8350 break;
8351 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8352 what = fw;
8353 break;
8354 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8355 what = fh;
8356 break;
8359 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8360 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8361 make_number (32),
8362 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8363 Fcons
8364 (make_unibyte_string (fs,
8365 strlen (fs)),
8366 Qnil)));
8367 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8368 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8369 make_number (32),
8370 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8371 Fcons
8372 (make_unibyte_string (fh,
8373 strlen (fh)),
8374 Qnil)));
8375 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8376 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8377 make_number (32),
8378 Fcons (make_number (0), /* Remove */
8379 Fcons
8380 (make_unibyte_string (fw,
8381 strlen (fw)),
8382 Qnil)));
8383 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8384 if (what != NULL)
8385 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8386 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8387 make_number (32),
8388 Fcons (make_number (1), /* Add */
8389 Fcons
8390 (make_unibyte_string (what,
8391 strlen (what)),
8392 Qnil)));
8395 return have_net_atom;
8398 static void
8399 XTfullscreen_hook (f)
8400 FRAME_PTR f;
8402 if (f->async_visible)
8404 BLOCK_INPUT;
8405 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f);
8406 x_sync (f);
8407 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8412 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8413 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8414 static void
8415 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8416 struct frame *f;
8418 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8420 int width, height, ign;
8422 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8423 return;
8425 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8427 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8429 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8430 when setting WM manager hints.
8431 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8432 x_check_expected_move. */
8433 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8435 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8436 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8437 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8439 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8440 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8445 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8446 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8447 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8448 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8449 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8450 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8451 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8453 static void
8454 x_check_expected_move (f, expected_left, expected_top)
8455 struct frame *f;
8456 int expected_left;
8457 int expected_top;
8459 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8461 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8462 window manager window around the frame. */
8464 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8466 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8468 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8470 int adjusted_left;
8471 int adjusted_top;
8473 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8474 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8475 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8477 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8479 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8480 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8482 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8483 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8485 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8487 else
8488 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8489 frame's position. */
8491 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8495 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8496 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8497 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8498 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8499 of an exact comparison. */
8501 static void
8502 x_sync_with_move (f, left, top, fuzzy)
8503 struct frame *f;
8504 int left, top, fuzzy;
8506 int count = 0;
8508 while (count++ < 50)
8510 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8512 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8513 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8514 loop. */
8516 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8517 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8519 if (fuzzy)
8521 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8522 pixels. */
8524 if (abs (current_left - left) <= 10 && abs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8525 return;
8527 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8528 return;
8531 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8532 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8534 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8538 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8539 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8540 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8541 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8543 static void
8544 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8545 struct frame *f;
8546 int change_gravity;
8547 int cols, rows;
8549 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8551 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8552 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8553 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8555 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8556 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8557 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8559 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8561 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8562 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8564 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8565 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8567 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8568 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8569 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8571 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8572 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8573 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8574 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8576 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8577 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8578 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8579 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8580 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8582 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8583 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8584 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8585 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8586 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8588 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8589 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8590 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8591 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8592 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8594 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8598 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8599 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8600 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8601 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8603 void
8604 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8605 struct frame *f;
8606 int change_gravity;
8607 int cols, rows;
8609 BLOCK_INPUT;
8611 #ifdef USE_GTK
8612 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8613 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8614 else
8615 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8616 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8618 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8620 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8621 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8622 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8623 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8624 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8625 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8626 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8627 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8628 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8630 else
8631 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8633 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8635 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8637 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8639 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8640 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8642 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8643 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8644 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8645 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8646 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8648 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8651 /* Mouse warping. */
8653 void
8654 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8655 struct frame *f;
8656 int x, y;
8658 int pix_x, pix_y;
8660 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8661 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8663 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8664 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8666 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8667 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8669 BLOCK_INPUT;
8671 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8672 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8673 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8676 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8678 void
8679 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8680 struct frame *f;
8681 int pix_x, pix_y;
8683 BLOCK_INPUT;
8685 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8686 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8687 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8690 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8692 void
8693 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8694 struct frame *f;
8696 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8697 x_raise_frame (f);
8698 #endif
8699 #if 0
8700 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8701 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8702 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8703 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8704 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8705 #endif /* ! 0 */
8708 void
8709 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8710 struct frame *f;
8712 #if 0
8713 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8714 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8715 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8716 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8717 #endif /* ! 0 */
8720 /* Raise frame F. */
8722 void
8723 x_raise_frame (f)
8724 struct frame *f;
8726 BLOCK_INPUT;
8727 if (f->async_visible)
8728 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8730 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8731 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8734 /* Lower frame F. */
8736 void
8737 x_lower_frame (f)
8738 struct frame *f;
8740 if (f->async_visible)
8742 BLOCK_INPUT;
8743 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8744 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8745 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8749 static void
8750 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8751 FRAME_PTR f;
8752 int raise_flag;
8754 if (raise_flag)
8756 /* The following code is needed for `raise-frame' to work on
8757 some versions of metacity; see Window Manager
8758 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8759 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Standards_2fwm_2dspec
8761 However, on other versions (metacity 2.17.2-1.fc7), it
8762 reportedly causes hangs when resizing frames. */
8764 /* Lisp_Object frame;
8765 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW"; */
8767 x_raise_frame (f);
8769 /* XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8770 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8771 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8772 make_number (32),
8773 Fcons (make_number (1),
8774 Fcons (make_number (time (NULL) * 1000),
8775 Qnil))); */
8777 else
8778 x_lower_frame (f);
8781 /* Change of visibility. */
8783 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8784 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8785 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8786 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8787 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8788 finishes with it. */
8790 void
8791 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8792 struct frame *f;
8794 Lisp_Object type;
8795 int original_top, original_left;
8796 int retry_count = 2;
8798 retry:
8800 BLOCK_INPUT;
8802 type = x_icon_type (f);
8803 if (!NILP (type))
8804 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8806 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8808 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8809 call x_set_offset a second time
8810 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8811 before the window gets really visible. */
8812 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8813 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8814 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8816 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8818 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8819 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8820 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8821 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8822 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8823 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8824 #ifdef USE_GTK
8825 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8826 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8827 #else
8828 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8829 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8830 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8831 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8832 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8833 to come back ok without this. */
8834 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8835 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8836 #endif
8839 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8841 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8842 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8843 so that incoming events are handled. */
8845 Lisp_Object frame;
8846 int count;
8847 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8848 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8849 will set it when they are handled. */
8850 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8852 original_left = f->left_pos;
8853 original_top = f->top_pos;
8855 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8856 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8858 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8860 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8861 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8862 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8863 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8865 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8866 because the window manager may choose the position
8867 and we don't want to override it. */
8869 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8870 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8871 && previously_visible)
8873 Drawable rootw;
8874 int x, y;
8875 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8877 BLOCK_INPUT;
8879 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8880 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8881 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8882 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8883 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8884 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8885 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8886 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8887 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8889 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8890 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8891 original_left, original_top);
8893 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8896 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8898 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8899 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8900 MapNotify at all.. */
8901 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8902 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8904 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8905 x_sync (f);
8907 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8908 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8909 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8910 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8911 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8912 probably a bug. */
8913 if (input_polling_used ())
8915 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8916 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8917 handler reset it. */
8918 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8919 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8920 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8921 poll_for_input_1 ();
8922 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8925 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8926 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8929 /* 2000-09-28: In
8931 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8932 (iconify-frame f)
8933 (raise-frame f))
8935 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8936 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8937 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8938 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8940 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8941 goto retry;
8945 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8947 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8949 void
8950 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8951 struct frame *f;
8953 Window window;
8955 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8956 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8958 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8959 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8960 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8962 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8963 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8964 return;
8965 #endif
8967 BLOCK_INPUT;
8969 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8970 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8971 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8972 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8973 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8974 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8976 #ifdef USE_GTK
8977 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8978 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8979 else
8980 #endif
8982 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8984 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8985 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8987 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8988 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8990 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8992 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8993 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8995 XEvent unmap;
8997 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8998 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8999 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9000 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
9001 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9002 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9003 False,
9004 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
9005 &unmap))
9007 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9008 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
9012 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
9013 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
9014 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
9017 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9018 just by the event that we get from the server.
9019 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9020 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9021 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9022 f->visible = 0;
9023 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9024 f->async_visible = 0;
9025 f->async_iconified = 0;
9027 x_sync (f);
9029 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9032 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9034 void
9035 x_iconify_frame (f)
9036 struct frame *f;
9038 int result;
9039 Lisp_Object type;
9041 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9042 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9043 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9045 if (f->async_iconified)
9046 return;
9048 BLOCK_INPUT;
9050 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9052 type = x_icon_type (f);
9053 if (!NILP (type))
9054 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9056 #ifdef USE_GTK
9057 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9059 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9060 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9062 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9063 f->iconified = 1;
9064 f->visible = 1;
9065 f->async_iconified = 1;
9066 f->async_visible = 0;
9067 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9068 return;
9070 #endif
9072 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9074 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9076 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9077 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9078 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9079 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9080 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9081 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9082 so we have to record it here. */
9083 f->iconified = 1;
9084 f->visible = 1;
9085 f->async_iconified = 1;
9086 f->async_visible = 0;
9087 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9088 return;
9091 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9092 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9093 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9094 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9096 if (!result)
9097 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9099 f->async_iconified = 1;
9100 f->async_visible = 0;
9103 BLOCK_INPUT;
9104 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9105 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9106 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9108 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9109 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9110 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9111 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9113 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9114 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9116 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9117 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9119 XEvent message;
9121 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9122 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9123 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9124 message.xclient.format = 32;
9125 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9127 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9128 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9129 False,
9130 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9131 &message))
9133 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9134 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9138 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9139 IconicState. */
9140 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9142 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9144 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9145 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9148 f->async_iconified = 1;
9149 f->async_visible = 0;
9151 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9152 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9153 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9157 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9159 void
9160 x_free_frame_resources (f)
9161 struct frame *f;
9163 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9164 Lisp_Object bar;
9165 struct scroll_bar *b;
9167 BLOCK_INPUT;
9169 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9170 commands to the X server. */
9171 if (dpyinfo->display)
9173 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9174 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9176 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9177 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9178 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9179 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9180 toolkit scroll bars. */
9181 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9183 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9184 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9186 #endif
9188 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9189 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9190 free_frame_xic (f);
9191 #endif
9193 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9194 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9196 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9197 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9199 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9200 we are using a toolkit. */
9201 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9202 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9204 free_frame_menubar (f);
9205 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9207 #ifdef USE_GTK
9208 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9209 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9210 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9212 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9213 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9214 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9216 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9218 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9219 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9220 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9222 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
9223 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
9224 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9225 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9226 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9227 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9229 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9230 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9231 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9232 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9233 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9234 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9235 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9236 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9237 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9238 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9239 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9240 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9241 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9242 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9243 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9245 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9246 free_frame_faces (f);
9248 x_free_gcs (f);
9249 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9252 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9253 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9255 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9256 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9258 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9259 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9260 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9261 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9262 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9263 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9265 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9267 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9268 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9269 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9270 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9271 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9272 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9273 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9276 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9280 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9282 void
9283 x_destroy_window (f)
9284 struct frame *f;
9286 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9288 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9289 commands to the X server. */
9290 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9291 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9293 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9297 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9299 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9300 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9301 that the window now has.
9302 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9303 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9304 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9306 #ifndef USE_GTK
9307 void
9308 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9309 struct frame *f;
9310 long flags;
9311 int user_position;
9313 XSizeHints size_hints;
9315 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9316 Arg al[2];
9317 int ac = 0;
9318 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9319 #endif
9321 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9323 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9324 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9326 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9327 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9329 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9330 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9331 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9332 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9333 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9334 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9335 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9336 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9337 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9338 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9340 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9341 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9342 size_hints.max_width
9343 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9344 size_hints.max_height
9345 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9347 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9349 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9350 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9351 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9353 int base_width, base_height;
9354 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9356 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9357 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9359 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9361 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9362 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9363 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9364 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9365 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9367 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9368 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9369 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9371 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9372 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9373 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9374 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9375 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9376 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9377 #else
9378 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9379 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9380 #endif
9383 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9384 if (flags)
9386 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9387 goto no_read;
9389 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9392 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9393 long supplied_return;
9394 int value;
9396 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9397 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9398 &supplied_return);
9399 #else
9400 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9401 #endif
9403 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9404 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9405 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9406 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9407 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9408 #endif
9410 if (flags)
9411 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9412 else
9414 if (value == 0)
9415 hints.flags = 0;
9416 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9417 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9418 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9419 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9420 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9421 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9422 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9423 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9427 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9428 no_read:
9429 #endif
9431 #ifdef PWinGravity
9432 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9433 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9435 if (user_position)
9437 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9438 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9440 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9442 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9443 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9444 #else
9445 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9446 #endif
9448 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9450 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9452 void
9453 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9454 struct frame *f;
9455 int state;
9457 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9458 Arg al[1];
9460 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9461 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9462 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9463 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9465 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9466 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9468 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9469 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9472 void
9473 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9474 struct frame *f;
9475 int pixmap_id;
9477 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9479 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9480 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9481 #endif
9483 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9485 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9486 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9487 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9488 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9490 else
9492 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9493 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9494 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9495 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9496 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9497 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9498 best to explicitly give up. */
9499 #if 0
9500 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9501 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9502 #else
9503 return;
9504 #endif
9508 #ifdef USE_GTK
9510 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9511 return;
9514 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9517 Arg al[1];
9518 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9519 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9520 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9521 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9524 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9526 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9527 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9529 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9532 void
9533 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9534 struct frame *f;
9535 int icon_x, icon_y;
9537 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9539 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9540 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9541 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9543 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9547 /***********************************************************************
9548 Fonts
9549 ***********************************************************************/
9551 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9553 struct font_info *
9554 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9555 FRAME_PTR f;
9556 int font_idx;
9558 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9562 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9564 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9565 to be listed.
9567 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9569 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9570 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9571 on how many fonts to match. */
9573 Lisp_Object
9574 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9575 struct frame *f;
9576 Lisp_Object pattern;
9577 int size;
9578 int maxnames;
9580 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9581 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9582 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9583 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9584 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9585 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9586 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9588 if (size < 0)
9590 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9591 size = 0;
9594 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9595 if (NILP (patterns))
9596 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9598 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9599 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9600 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9602 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9604 int num_fonts;
9605 char **names = NULL;
9607 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9608 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9609 The cache is an alist of the form:
9610 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9611 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9612 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9613 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9614 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9615 if (!NILP (list))
9617 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9618 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9619 goto label_cached;
9622 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9624 BLOCK_INPUT;
9625 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9627 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9629 XFontStruct *font;
9630 unsigned long value;
9632 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9633 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9635 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9636 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9637 font = NULL;
9638 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9641 if (font
9642 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9644 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9645 int len = strlen (name);
9646 char *tmp;
9648 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9649 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9650 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9651 if (len == 0)
9652 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9653 else
9655 num_fonts = 1;
9656 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9657 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9658 simple var. */
9659 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9660 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9661 XFree (name);
9664 else
9665 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9667 if (font)
9668 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9671 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9673 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9674 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9675 if (maxnames < 0)
9677 int limit;
9679 for (limit = 500;;)
9681 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9682 if (num_fonts == limit)
9684 BLOCK_INPUT;
9685 XFreeFontNames (names);
9686 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9687 limit *= 2;
9689 else
9690 break;
9693 else
9694 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9695 &num_fonts);
9697 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9699 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9700 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9701 names = NULL;
9702 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9706 x_uncatch_errors ();
9707 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9709 if (names)
9711 int i;
9713 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9714 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9715 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9717 int width = 0;
9718 char *p = names[i];
9719 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9721 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9722 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9723 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9724 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9725 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9726 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9727 while (*p)
9728 if (*p++ == '-')
9730 dashes++;
9731 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9732 width = atoi (p);
9733 else if (dashes == 9)
9734 resx = atoi (p);
9735 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9736 average_width = atoi (p);
9739 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9740 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9742 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9743 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9745 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9746 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9747 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9748 >= 0))
9749 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9750 width of this font. */
9751 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9752 else
9753 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9754 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9759 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9761 BLOCK_INPUT;
9762 XFreeFontNames (names);
9763 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9767 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9768 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9769 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9771 label_cached:
9772 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9774 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9775 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9776 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9778 int found_size;
9780 tem = XCAR (list);
9782 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9783 continue;
9784 if (!size)
9786 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9787 continue;
9790 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9792 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9793 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9794 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9796 BLOCK_INPUT;
9797 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9798 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9799 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9800 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9802 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9803 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9804 thisinfo = NULL;
9805 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9807 x_uncatch_errors ();
9808 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9810 if (thisinfo)
9812 XSETCDR (tem,
9813 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9814 ? make_number (0)
9815 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9816 BLOCK_INPUT;
9817 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9818 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9820 else
9821 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9822 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9823 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9824 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9827 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9828 if (found_size == size)
9829 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9830 else if (found_size > 0)
9832 if (NILP (second_best))
9833 second_best = tem;
9834 else if (found_size < size)
9836 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9837 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9838 second_best = tem;
9840 else
9842 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9843 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9844 second_best = tem;
9848 if (!NILP (newlist))
9849 break;
9850 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9852 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9853 break;
9857 return newlist;
9861 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9863 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9864 font table. */
9866 static void
9867 x_check_font (f, font)
9868 struct frame *f;
9869 XFontStruct *font;
9871 int i;
9872 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9874 xassert (font != NULL);
9876 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9877 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9878 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9879 break;
9881 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9884 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9886 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9887 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9888 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9889 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9890 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9892 static INLINE void
9893 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9894 XFontStruct *font;
9895 int *w, *h;
9897 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9898 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9900 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9901 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9902 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9903 if (*w <= 0)
9904 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9908 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9909 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9910 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9911 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9912 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9914 static int
9915 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9916 struct frame *f;
9918 int i;
9919 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9920 XFontStruct *font;
9921 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9922 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9924 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9925 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9927 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9928 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9930 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9931 int w, h;
9933 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9934 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9935 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9937 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9938 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9941 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9942 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9944 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9945 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9946 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9950 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9951 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9952 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9953 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9955 struct font_info *
9956 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9957 struct frame *f;
9958 register char *fontname;
9959 int size;
9961 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9962 Lisp_Object font_names;
9964 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9965 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9966 we already have by comparing names. */
9967 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9969 if (!NILP (font_names))
9971 Lisp_Object tail;
9972 int i;
9974 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9975 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9976 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9977 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9978 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9979 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9980 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9981 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9984 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9986 char *full_name;
9987 XFontStruct *font;
9988 struct font_info *fontp;
9989 unsigned long value;
9990 int i;
9992 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9993 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9994 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9995 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9996 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9997 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9998 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
10000 BLOCK_INPUT;
10001 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10002 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
10003 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
10005 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
10006 server. Let's just ignore it. */
10007 font = NULL;
10008 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10010 x_uncatch_errors ();
10011 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10012 if (!font)
10013 return NULL;
10015 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
10016 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
10017 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
10018 break;
10020 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
10021 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
10022 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
10024 int sz;
10025 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
10026 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
10027 dpyinfo->font_table
10028 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
10031 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
10032 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
10033 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
10035 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
10036 BLOCK_INPUT;
10037 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
10038 fontp->font = font;
10039 fontp->font_idx = i;
10040 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
10041 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
10043 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
10045 /* Fixed width font. */
10046 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
10048 else
10050 XChar2b char2b;
10051 XCharStruct *pcm;
10053 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
10054 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
10055 if (pcm)
10056 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
10057 else
10058 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10060 fontp->average_width
10061 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
10062 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
10063 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
10064 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
10065 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
10067 if (pcm)
10069 int width = pcm->width;
10070 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
10071 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
10072 width += pcm->width;
10073 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
10075 else
10076 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
10080 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
10081 full_name = 0;
10082 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
10084 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
10085 char *p = name;
10086 int dashes = 0;
10088 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
10089 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
10090 so don't use it.
10091 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
10092 stored in them. */
10093 while (*p)
10095 if (*p == '-')
10096 dashes++;
10097 p++;
10100 if (dashes >= 13)
10102 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
10103 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
10106 XFree (name);
10109 if (full_name != 0)
10110 fontp->full_name = full_name;
10111 else
10112 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
10114 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
10115 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
10117 if (NILP (font_names))
10119 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
10120 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
10121 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
10122 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
10123 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
10124 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
10125 Qnil);
10127 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10128 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10129 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10130 make_number (fontp->size)),
10131 Qnil)),
10132 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10133 if (full_name)
10135 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
10136 Qnil);
10137 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
10138 Fcons (Fcons (key,
10139 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
10140 make_number (fontp->size)),
10141 Qnil)),
10142 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
10146 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
10147 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
10148 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
10149 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
10150 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
10151 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
10152 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
10153 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
10154 fontp->encoding[1]
10155 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
10156 /* 1-byte font */
10157 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10158 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10159 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
10160 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
10161 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
10162 /* 2-byte font */
10163 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
10164 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
10165 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10166 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10167 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
10168 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
10169 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
10170 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
10171 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10172 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
10173 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
10174 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
10175 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
10177 fontp->baseline_offset
10178 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
10179 ? (long) value : 0);
10180 fontp->relative_compose
10181 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
10182 ? (long) value : 0);
10183 fontp->default_ascent
10184 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
10185 ? (long) value : 0);
10187 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
10188 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
10189 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
10190 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
10191 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
10192 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
10193 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10194 return fontp;
10199 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
10200 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
10202 struct font_info *
10203 x_query_font (f, fontname)
10204 struct frame *f;
10205 register char *fontname;
10207 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10208 int i;
10210 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10211 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
10212 && (!xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
10213 || !xstricmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
10214 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
10215 return NULL;
10219 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
10220 `encoder' of the structure. */
10222 void
10223 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
10224 struct font_info *fontp;
10226 Lisp_Object list, elt;
10228 elt = Qnil;
10229 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
10231 elt = XCAR (list);
10232 if (CONSP (elt)
10233 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
10234 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
10235 >= 0)
10236 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
10237 >= 0)))
10238 break;
10241 if (! NILP (list))
10243 struct ccl_program *ccl
10244 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
10246 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
10247 xfree (ccl);
10248 else
10249 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
10255 /***********************************************************************
10256 Initialization
10257 ***********************************************************************/
10259 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10260 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10261 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10262 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10264 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10265 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10266 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10268 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10269 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10270 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10271 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10272 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10273 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10274 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10277 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
10279 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
10281 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10283 static int x_initialized;
10285 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10286 static int x_session_initialized;
10287 #endif
10289 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10290 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10291 the screen number from the server number. */
10292 static int
10293 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10294 const char *name1, *name2;
10296 int seen_colon = 0;
10297 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10298 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10299 int length_until_period = 0;
10301 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10302 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10303 length_until_period++;
10305 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10306 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10307 name1 += 4;
10308 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10309 name2 += 4;
10310 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10311 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10312 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10313 name1 += system_name_length;
10314 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10315 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10316 name2 += system_name_length;
10317 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10318 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10319 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10320 name1 += length_until_period;
10321 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10322 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10323 name2 += length_until_period;
10325 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10327 if (*name1 == ':')
10328 seen_colon++;
10329 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10330 return 1;
10332 return (seen_colon
10333 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10334 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10336 #endif
10338 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10339 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10340 to 5. */
10341 static void
10342 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10343 unsigned long mask;
10344 int *bits;
10345 int *offset;
10347 int nr = 0;
10348 int off = 0;
10350 while (!(mask & 1))
10352 off++;
10353 mask >>= 1;
10356 while (mask & 1)
10358 nr++;
10359 mask >>= 1;
10362 *offset = off;
10363 *bits = nr;
10367 x_display_ok (display)
10368 const char * display;
10370 int dpy_ok = 1;
10371 Display *dpy;
10373 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10374 if (dpy)
10375 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
10376 else
10377 dpy_ok = 0;
10378 return dpy_ok;
10381 struct x_display_info *
10382 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10383 Lisp_Object display_name;
10384 char *xrm_option;
10385 char *resource_name;
10387 int connection;
10388 Display *dpy;
10389 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10390 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10392 BLOCK_INPUT;
10394 if (!x_initialized)
10396 x_initialize ();
10397 ++x_initialized;
10400 #ifdef USE_GTK
10402 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10403 int argc;
10404 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10405 char **argv2 = argv;
10406 GdkAtom atom;
10408 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10410 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10411 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10412 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10413 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10414 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10416 else
10418 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10419 argv[argc] = 0;
10421 argc = 0;
10422 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10424 if (! NILP (display_name))
10426 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10427 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10430 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10431 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10433 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10434 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10435 #endif
10437 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10439 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10440 fixup_locale ();
10441 xg_initialize ();
10443 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10445 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10446 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10448 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10450 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10451 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10453 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10454 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10456 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10457 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10460 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10461 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10464 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10465 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10466 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10467 errors with X11R5:
10468 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10469 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10470 So let's not use it until R6. */
10471 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10472 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10473 #endif
10476 int argc = 0;
10477 char *argv[3];
10479 argv[0] = "";
10480 argc = 1;
10481 if (xrm_option)
10483 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10484 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10486 turn_on_atimers (0);
10487 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10488 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10489 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10490 &argc, argv);
10491 turn_on_atimers (1);
10493 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10494 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10495 fixup_locale ();
10496 #endif
10499 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10500 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10501 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10502 #endif
10503 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10504 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10505 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10507 /* Detect failure. */
10508 if (dpy == 0)
10510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10511 return 0;
10514 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10516 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10517 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10519 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10521 struct x_display_info *share;
10522 Lisp_Object tail;
10524 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10525 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10526 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10527 SDATA (display_name)))
10528 break;
10529 if (share)
10530 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10531 else
10533 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10534 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10535 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10537 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10538 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10539 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10540 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10541 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10542 BLOCK_INPUT;
10545 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10546 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10547 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10548 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10549 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10550 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10551 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10553 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10555 #endif
10557 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10558 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10559 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10561 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10562 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10563 x_display_name_list);
10564 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10566 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10568 #if 0
10569 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10570 #endif /* ! 0 */
10572 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10573 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10574 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10575 + 2);
10576 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10577 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10579 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10580 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10582 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10583 #ifdef USE_GTK
10584 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10585 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10586 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10588 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10589 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10591 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10592 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10593 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10594 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10595 #else
10596 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10597 #endif
10598 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10599 all versions. */
10600 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10602 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10603 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10604 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10605 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10606 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10607 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10608 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10609 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10610 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10611 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10612 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10613 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10614 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10615 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10616 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10617 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10618 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10619 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10620 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10621 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10622 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10623 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10624 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10625 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10626 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10627 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10628 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10629 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10630 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10631 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10632 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10633 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10634 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10636 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10637 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10638 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10640 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10642 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10643 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10644 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10645 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10646 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10647 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10650 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10651 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10653 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10655 Lisp_Object value;
10656 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10657 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10658 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10659 Qnil, Qnil);
10660 if (STRINGP (value)
10661 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10662 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10663 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10666 else
10667 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10668 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10671 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10672 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10673 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10674 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10675 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10676 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10677 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10678 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10679 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10682 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10683 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10684 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10685 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10686 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10687 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10688 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10689 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10690 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10691 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10692 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10693 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10694 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10695 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10696 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10697 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10698 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10699 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10700 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10701 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10702 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10703 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10704 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10705 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10706 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10707 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10708 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10709 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10710 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10711 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10712 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10713 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10714 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10715 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10716 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10717 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10718 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10719 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10720 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10721 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10722 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10723 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10724 /* For properties of font. */
10725 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10726 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10727 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10728 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10729 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10730 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10731 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10732 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10733 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10734 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10736 /* Ghostscript support. */
10737 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10738 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10740 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10741 False);
10743 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10745 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10746 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10747 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10748 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10750 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10751 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10754 char null_bits[1];
10756 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10758 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10759 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10760 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10765 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10766 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10767 dpyinfo->gray
10768 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10769 gray_bitmap_bits,
10770 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10771 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10774 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10775 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10776 #endif
10778 #ifdef subprocesses
10779 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10780 if (connection != 0)
10781 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10782 #endif
10784 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10785 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10786 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10787 /* stdin is a socket here */
10788 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10789 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10790 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10791 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10792 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10793 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10795 #ifdef SIGIO
10796 if (interrupt_input)
10797 init_sigio (connection);
10798 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10800 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10801 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10802 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10803 so that Xt does not crash. */
10805 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10806 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10807 Font font;
10809 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10810 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10811 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10812 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10813 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10814 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10815 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10816 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10817 abort ();
10818 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10819 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10820 x_uncatch_errors ();
10822 #endif
10823 #endif
10825 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10826 for debugging X code. */
10828 Lisp_Object value;
10829 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10830 build_string ("synchronous"),
10831 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10832 Qnil, Qnil);
10833 if (STRINGP (value)
10834 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10835 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10836 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10840 Lisp_Object value;
10841 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10842 build_string ("useXIM"),
10843 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10844 Qnil, Qnil);
10845 #ifdef USE_XIM
10846 if (STRINGP (value)
10847 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10848 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10849 use_xim = 0;
10850 #else
10851 if (STRINGP (value)
10852 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10853 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10854 use_xim = 1;
10855 #endif
10858 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10859 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10860 if (!x_session_initialized++)
10861 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10862 #endif
10864 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10866 return dpyinfo;
10869 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10870 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10872 void
10873 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10874 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10876 int i;
10878 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10880 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10881 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10882 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10883 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10884 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10885 else
10887 Lisp_Object tail;
10889 tail = x_display_name_list;
10890 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10892 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10894 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10895 break;
10897 tail = XCDR (tail);
10901 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10902 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10904 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10905 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10906 else
10908 struct x_display_info *tail;
10910 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10911 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10912 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10915 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10916 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10917 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10918 #endif
10919 #endif
10920 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10921 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10922 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10923 #endif
10924 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10925 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10926 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10927 #endif
10929 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10930 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10931 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10933 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10934 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10935 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10938 if (dpyinfo->font_table)
10940 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10941 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10942 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10944 if (dpyinfo->x_id_name)
10945 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10946 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
10947 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10948 xfree (dpyinfo);
10951 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10953 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10954 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10955 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10956 that slows us down. */
10958 static void
10959 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10960 struct atimer *timer;
10962 BLOCK_INPUT;
10963 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10964 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10966 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10967 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10968 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10969 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10971 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10974 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10975 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10976 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10977 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10978 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10979 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10980 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10982 void
10983 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
10985 BLOCK_INPUT;
10986 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10988 EMACS_TIME interval;
10990 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10991 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10992 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10994 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10997 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11000 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
11002 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
11004 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
11006 x_frame_parm_handlers,
11007 x_produce_glyphs,
11008 x_write_glyphs,
11009 x_insert_glyphs,
11010 x_clear_end_of_line,
11011 x_scroll_run,
11012 x_after_update_window_line,
11013 x_update_window_begin,
11014 x_update_window_end,
11015 x_cursor_to,
11016 x_flush,
11017 #ifdef XFlush
11018 x_flush,
11019 #else
11020 0, /* flush_display_optional */
11021 #endif
11022 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
11023 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
11024 x_fix_overlapping_area,
11025 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
11026 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
11027 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
11028 x_per_char_metric,
11029 x_encode_char,
11030 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
11031 x_draw_glyph_string,
11032 x_define_frame_cursor,
11033 x_clear_frame_area,
11034 x_draw_window_cursor,
11035 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
11036 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
11039 void
11040 x_initialize ()
11042 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
11044 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
11045 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
11046 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
11047 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
11048 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
11049 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
11050 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
11051 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
11052 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
11053 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
11054 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
11055 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
11056 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
11057 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
11058 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
11059 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
11060 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
11061 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
11062 fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
11064 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
11065 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
11066 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
11067 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
11068 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
11069 off the bottom */
11070 baud_rate = 19200;
11072 x_noop_count = 0;
11073 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
11074 any_help_event_p = 0;
11075 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
11076 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
11077 x_session_initialized = 0;
11078 #endif
11080 #ifdef USE_GTK
11081 current_count = -1;
11082 #endif
11084 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
11085 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
11087 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11088 XtToolkitInitialize ();
11090 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
11092 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
11093 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
11094 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
11095 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
11096 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
11097 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
11098 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
11100 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
11101 #endif
11103 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11104 #ifndef USE_GTK
11105 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
11106 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
11107 #endif
11108 #endif
11110 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
11111 original error handler. */
11112 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11113 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11115 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
11116 #ifdef SIGWINCH
11117 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
11118 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
11120 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
11124 void
11125 syms_of_xterm ()
11127 x_error_message = NULL;
11129 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
11130 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
11132 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
11133 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
11135 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
11136 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
11138 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
11139 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
11140 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
11141 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
11143 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
11144 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
11146 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
11147 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
11148 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
11149 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
11150 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
11151 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
11152 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
11154 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
11155 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
11156 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
11157 nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the variable
11158 `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the baseline
11159 level. The default value is nil. */);
11160 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
11162 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
11163 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
11164 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
11165 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
11166 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
11167 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
11168 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
11169 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
11170 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
11172 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
11173 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
11174 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
11175 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
11176 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
11177 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
11178 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
11179 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
11180 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
11181 #elif USE_GTK
11182 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
11183 #else
11184 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
11185 #endif
11186 #else
11187 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
11188 #endif
11190 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
11191 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
11193 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
11194 Qalt = intern ("alt");
11195 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
11196 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
11197 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
11198 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
11199 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
11200 Qsuper = intern ("super");
11201 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
11203 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
11204 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
11205 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11206 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
11207 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
11208 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
11210 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
11211 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
11212 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11213 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
11214 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
11215 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
11217 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
11218 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
11219 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11220 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
11221 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
11222 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
11224 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
11225 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
11226 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
11227 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
11228 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
11229 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
11231 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
11232 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
11233 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
11234 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
11235 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
11236 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
11239 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
11241 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
11242 (do not change this comment) */